(browse-url-text-xterm): Unquote browse-url-text-browser.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobf8ef761c5f5dbd69e59a0a7d80b715950a141f2a
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
8 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
11 any later version.
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
20 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
21 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
23 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
24 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
26 #include <config.h>
28 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
29 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
30 #include <signal.h>
32 #include <stdio.h>
34 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
36 #include "lisp.h"
37 #include "blockinput.h"
39 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
40 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
41 #include "syssignal.h"
43 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
44 if this is not done before the other system files. */
45 #include "xterm.h"
46 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
48 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
49 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
50 #ifndef makedev
51 #include <sys/types.h>
52 #endif /* makedev */
54 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
55 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
56 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "character.h"
72 #include "coding.h"
73 #include "ccl.h"
74 #include "frame.h"
75 #include "dispextern.h"
76 #include "fontset.h"
77 #include "termhooks.h"
78 #include "termopts.h"
79 #include "termchar.h"
80 #include "emacs-icon.h"
81 #include "disptab.h"
82 #include "buffer.h"
83 #include "window.h"
84 #include "keyboard.h"
85 #include "intervals.h"
86 #include "process.h"
87 #include "atimer.h"
88 #include "keymap.h"
90 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
91 #include <X11/Shell.h>
92 #endif
94 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
95 #include <sys/time.h>
96 #endif
97 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
98 #include <unistd.h>
99 #endif
101 #ifdef USE_GTK
102 #include "gtkutil.h"
103 #endif
105 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
106 #include "font.h"
107 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
109 #ifdef USE_LUCID
110 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
111 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
112 #endif
114 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
116 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
117 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
118 int));
119 #endif
121 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
122 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
123 #define HACK_EDITRES
124 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
125 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
127 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
129 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
130 #if defined USE_MOTIF
131 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
132 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
133 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
135 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
136 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
139 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
141 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
142 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
143 #ifndef XtNpickTop
144 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
145 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
146 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
147 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
149 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
151 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
152 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
153 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
154 #endif
156 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
157 #include "widget.h"
158 #ifndef XtNinitialState
159 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
160 #endif
161 #endif
163 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
164 #ifdef USE_XIM
165 int use_xim = 1;
166 #else
167 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
168 #endif
172 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
174 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
176 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
177 start. */
179 static int any_help_event_p;
181 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
182 static Lisp_Object last_window;
184 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
186 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
188 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
190 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
192 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
193 use. */
195 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
197 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
198 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
199 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
200 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
202 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
204 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
205 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
206 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
207 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
209 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
211 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
213 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
215 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
216 /* The application context for Xt use. */
217 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
218 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
219 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
221 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
223 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
225 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
226 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
228 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
230 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
231 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
232 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
234 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
236 /* Mouse movement.
238 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
239 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
240 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
241 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
243 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
245 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
246 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
247 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
248 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
249 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
250 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
251 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
252 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
253 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
254 is off. */
256 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
258 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
259 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
260 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
262 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
264 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
265 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
266 an ordinary motion.
268 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
269 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
270 event. */
272 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
274 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
275 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
276 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
277 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
278 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
279 it's somewhat accurate. */
281 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
283 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
285 static Time last_user_time;
287 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
288 events. */
290 #ifdef __STDC__
291 static int volatile input_signal_count;
292 #else
293 static int input_signal_count;
294 #endif
296 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
298 static int x_noop_count;
300 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
302 extern char **initial_argv;
303 extern int initial_argc;
305 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
307 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
309 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
311 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
313 extern int errno;
315 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
317 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
319 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
321 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
322 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
323 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
325 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
326 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
328 /* Used in x_flush. */
330 extern Lisp_Object Vinhibit_redisplay;
332 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
333 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
335 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
336 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
338 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
340 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
341 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
342 void x_delete_terminal P_ ((struct terminal *));
343 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
344 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
345 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
346 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
348 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
349 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
350 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
351 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
352 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
353 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
354 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
355 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
356 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
357 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
358 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
359 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
360 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
361 enum text_cursor_kinds));
363 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
364 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
365 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
366 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
367 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
368 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
369 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
370 enum scroll_bar_part *,
371 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
372 unsigned long *));
373 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
374 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
375 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
376 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
377 int *, struct input_event *));
378 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
379 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
380 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
383 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
385 static void
386 x_flush (f)
387 struct frame *f;
389 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
390 connection may be broken. */
391 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
392 return;
394 BLOCK_INPUT;
395 if (f == NULL)
397 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
398 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
399 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
400 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
402 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
403 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
408 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
409 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
410 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
411 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
412 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
413 performance. */
415 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
418 /***********************************************************************
419 Debugging
420 ***********************************************************************/
422 #if 0
424 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
425 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
427 struct record
429 char *locus;
430 int type;
433 struct record event_record[100];
435 int event_record_index;
437 record_event (locus, type)
438 char *locus;
439 int type;
441 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
442 event_record_index = 0;
444 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
445 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
446 event_record_index++;
449 #endif /* 0 */
453 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
455 struct x_display_info *
456 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
457 Display *dpy;
459 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
461 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
462 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
463 return dpyinfo;
465 return 0;
470 /***********************************************************************
471 Starting and ending an update
472 ***********************************************************************/
474 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
475 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
476 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
477 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
478 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
480 static void
481 x_update_begin (f)
482 struct frame *f;
484 /* Nothing to do. */
488 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
489 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
490 position of W. */
492 static void
493 x_update_window_begin (w)
494 struct window *w;
496 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
497 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
499 updated_window = w;
500 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
502 BLOCK_INPUT;
504 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
506 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
507 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
509 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
510 highlighting. */
511 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
512 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
514 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
515 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
516 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
517 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
518 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
519 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
521 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
522 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
523 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
524 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
525 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
526 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
527 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
529 int i;
531 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
532 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
533 break;
535 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
536 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
538 #endif /* 0 */
541 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
545 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
547 static void
548 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
549 struct window *w;
550 int x, y0, y1;
552 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
553 struct face *face;
555 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
556 if (face)
557 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
558 face->foreground);
560 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
561 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
564 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
566 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
567 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
569 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
570 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
571 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
573 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
574 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
575 here. */
577 static void
578 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
579 struct window *w;
580 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
582 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
584 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
586 BLOCK_INPUT;
588 if (cursor_on_p)
589 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
590 output_cursor.vpos,
591 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
593 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
594 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
596 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
599 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
600 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
601 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
603 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
604 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
605 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
608 updated_window = NULL;
612 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
613 update_end. */
615 static void
616 x_update_end (f)
617 struct frame *f;
619 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
620 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
622 #ifndef XFlush
623 BLOCK_INPUT;
624 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
625 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
626 #endif
630 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
631 complete update has been performed. The global variable
632 updated_window is not available here. */
634 static void
635 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
636 struct frame *f;
638 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
640 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
642 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
643 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
645 BLOCK_INPUT;
646 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
647 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
648 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
649 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
650 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
651 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
657 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
658 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
659 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
660 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
661 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
662 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
664 static void
665 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
666 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
668 struct window *w = updated_window;
669 struct frame *f;
670 int width, height;
672 xassert (w);
674 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
675 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
677 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
678 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
679 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
680 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
681 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
682 overhead is very small. */
683 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
684 && desired_row->full_width_p
685 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
686 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
687 width != 0)
688 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
689 height > 0))
691 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
693 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
694 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
695 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
696 y -= width;
698 BLOCK_INPUT;
699 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
700 0, y, width, height, False);
701 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
702 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
703 y, width, height, False);
704 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
708 static void
709 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
710 struct window *w;
711 struct glyph_row *row;
712 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
714 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
715 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
716 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
717 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
718 struct face *face = p->face;
719 int rowY;
721 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
722 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
723 if (p->y < rowY)
725 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
726 visible last row. */
727 int oldY = row->y;
728 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
729 row->visible_height = p->h;
730 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
732 row->y = oldY;
733 row->visible_height = oldVH;
735 else
736 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
738 if (!p->overlay_p)
740 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
742 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
743 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
744 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
745 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
746 if (face->stipple)
747 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
748 else
749 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
751 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
752 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
753 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
754 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
755 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
756 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
757 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
758 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
760 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
762 if (sb_width > 0)
764 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
765 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
766 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
768 if (bx < 0)
770 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
771 if (left + width == p->x)
772 bx = left + sb_width;
773 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
774 bx = left;
775 if (bx >= 0)
777 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
779 nx = width - sb_width;
780 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
781 row->y));
782 ny = row->visible_height;
785 else
787 if (left + width == bx)
789 bx = left + sb_width;
790 nx += width - sb_width;
792 else if (bx + nx == left)
793 nx += width - sb_width;
797 #endif
798 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
799 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
801 if (!face->stipple)
802 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
805 if (p->which)
807 unsigned char *bits;
808 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
809 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
810 XGCValues gcv;
812 if (p->wd > 8)
813 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
814 else
815 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
817 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
818 by the server. */
819 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
820 (p->cursor_p
821 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
822 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
823 : face->foreground),
824 face->background, depth);
826 if (p->overlay_p)
828 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
829 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
830 bits, p->wd, p->h,
831 1, 0, 1);
832 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
833 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
834 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
835 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
838 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
839 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
840 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
842 if (p->overlay_p)
844 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
845 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
846 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
850 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
855 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
856 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
857 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
858 rarely happens). */
860 static void
861 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
865 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
866 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
868 static void
869 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
875 /***********************************************************************
876 Display Iterator
877 ***********************************************************************/
879 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
881 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *,
882 struct charset *, int *));
885 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
886 is not contained in the font. */
888 static XCharStruct *
889 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
890 XFontStruct *font;
891 XChar2b *char2b;
892 int font_type; /* unused on X */
894 /* The result metric information. */
895 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
897 xassert (font && char2b);
899 if (font->per_char != NULL)
901 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
903 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
904 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
905 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
906 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
907 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
908 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
909 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
910 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
911 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
912 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
914 else
916 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
917 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
918 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
919 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
921 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
922 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
924 where:
926 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
927 / = integer division
928 \ = integer modulus */
929 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
930 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
931 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
932 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
934 pcm = (font->per_char
935 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
936 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
937 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
941 else
943 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
944 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
945 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
946 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
947 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
948 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
951 return ((pcm == NULL
952 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
953 ? NULL : pcm);
957 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
958 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
960 static int
961 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, charset, two_byte_p)
962 int c;
963 XChar2b *char2b;
964 struct font_info *font_info;
965 struct charset *charset;
966 int *two_byte_p;
968 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
970 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
971 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
972 fixed encoding. */
973 if (font_info->font_encoder)
975 /* It's a program. */
976 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
978 check_ccl_update (ccl);
979 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
981 ccl->reg[0] = CHARSET_ID (charset);
982 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
983 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
985 else
987 ccl->reg[0] = CHARSET_ID (charset);
988 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
989 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
992 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, Qnil);
994 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
995 program. */
996 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
997 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, ccl->reg[1]);
998 else
999 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, ccl->reg[1], ccl->reg[2]);
1001 else if (font_info->encoding_type)
1003 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1004 encoding numbers. */
1005 unsigned char enc = font_info->encoding_type;
1007 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1008 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1009 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1011 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1012 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1015 if (two_byte_p)
1016 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1018 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
1023 /***********************************************************************
1024 Glyph display
1025 ***********************************************************************/
1029 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1030 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1031 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
1032 int));
1033 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1034 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1035 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1036 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1037 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1038 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1039 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1040 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1041 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
1042 unsigned long *, double, int));
1043 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
1044 double, int, unsigned long));
1045 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1046 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1047 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1048 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
1049 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
1050 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
1051 int, int, int));
1052 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
1053 int, int, int, int, int, int,
1054 XRectangle *));
1055 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
1056 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
1058 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
1059 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
1060 #endif
1063 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1064 face. */
1066 static void
1067 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1068 struct glyph_string *s;
1070 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1071 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1072 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1073 && !s->cmp)
1074 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1075 else
1077 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1078 XGCValues xgcv;
1079 unsigned long mask;
1081 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1082 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1084 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1085 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1086 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1087 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1088 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1089 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1090 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1092 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1093 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1094 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1096 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1097 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1100 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1101 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1102 if (enable_font_backend)
1103 xgcv.font = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->font->fid;
1104 else
1105 #endif
1106 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1107 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1108 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1110 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1111 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1112 mask, &xgcv);
1113 else
1114 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1115 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1117 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1122 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1124 static void
1125 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1126 struct glyph_string *s;
1128 int face_id;
1129 struct face *face;
1131 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1132 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1133 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1134 if (face == NULL)
1135 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1137 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1138 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1139 else
1140 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1141 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1142 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1144 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1145 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1146 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1147 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1148 else if (enable_font_backend)
1149 /* No need of setting a font for s->gc. */
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1152 else
1154 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1155 but font FONT. */
1156 XGCValues xgcv;
1157 unsigned long mask;
1159 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1160 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1161 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1162 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1163 if (enable_font_backend)
1164 xgcv.font = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->font->fid;
1165 else
1166 #endif
1167 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1168 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1169 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1171 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1172 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1173 mask, &xgcv);
1174 else
1175 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1176 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1178 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1181 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1185 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1186 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1187 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1189 static INLINE void
1190 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1191 struct glyph_string *s;
1193 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1197 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1198 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1199 pattern. */
1201 static INLINE void
1202 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1205 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1207 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1209 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1210 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1212 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1214 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1215 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1217 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1219 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1220 s->stippled_p = 0;
1222 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1224 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1225 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1227 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1228 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1230 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1231 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1233 else
1235 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1236 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1239 /* GC must have been set. */
1240 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1244 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1245 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1247 static INLINE void
1248 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1249 struct glyph_string *s;
1251 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1252 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1253 #else
1254 XRectangle r[2];
1255 #endif
1256 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1258 if (n > 0)
1259 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1260 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1261 s->num_clips = n;
1262 #endif
1266 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1267 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1268 the area of SRC. */
1270 static void
1271 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (src, dst)
1272 struct glyph_string *src, *dst;
1274 XRectangle r;
1276 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1277 if (enable_font_backend)
1279 r.x = src->x;
1280 r.width = src->width;
1281 r.y = src->y;
1282 r.height = src->height;
1283 dst->clip[0] = r;
1284 dst->num_clips = 1;
1286 else
1288 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1289 struct glyph_string *clip_head = src->clip_head;
1290 struct glyph_string *clip_tail = src->clip_tail;
1292 /* This foces clipping just this glyph string. */
1293 src->clip_head = src->clip_tail = src;
1294 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (src, &r);
1295 src->clip_head = clip_head, src->clip_tail = clip_tail;
1296 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1298 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1299 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1303 /* RIF:
1304 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1306 static void
1307 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1308 struct glyph_string *s;
1310 if (s->cmp == NULL
1311 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1313 XCharStruct cs;
1314 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1316 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1317 if (enable_font_backend)
1319 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1320 struct font *font = (struct font *) s->font_info;
1321 struct font_metrics metrics;
1322 int i;
1324 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1325 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1326 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1327 cs.rbearing = metrics.rbearing;
1328 cs.lbearing = metrics.lbearing;
1329 cs.width = metrics.width;
1331 else
1332 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1333 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1334 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1335 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1336 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1338 else if (s->cmp)
1340 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1341 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1346 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1348 static INLINE void
1349 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1350 struct glyph_string *s;
1351 int x, y, w, h;
1353 XGCValues xgcv;
1354 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1355 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1356 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1357 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1361 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1362 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1363 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1364 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1365 contains the first component of a composition. */
1367 static void
1368 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1369 struct glyph_string *s;
1370 int force_p;
1372 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1373 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1374 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1376 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1378 if (s->stippled_p)
1380 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1381 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1382 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1383 s->y + box_line_width,
1384 s->background_width,
1385 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1386 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1387 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1389 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1390 || s->font_not_found_p
1391 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1392 || force_p)
1394 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1395 s->background_width,
1396 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1397 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1403 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1405 static void
1406 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1407 struct glyph_string *s;
1409 int i, x;
1411 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1412 of S to the right of that box line. */
1413 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1414 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1415 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1416 else
1417 x = s->x;
1419 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1420 loaded. */
1421 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1423 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1425 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1426 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1427 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1428 s->height - 1);
1429 x += g->pixel_width;
1432 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1433 else if (enable_font_backend)
1435 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1436 struct font *font = (struct font *) s->font_info;
1437 int y;
1439 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1440 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1442 y = s->ybase - boff;
1443 if (s->for_overlaps
1444 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1445 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1446 else
1447 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1448 if (s->face->overstrike)
1449 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1451 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1452 else
1454 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1455 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1457 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1458 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1460 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1461 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1462 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1463 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1465 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1466 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1467 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1468 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1469 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1470 if (s->for_overlaps
1471 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1473 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1474 if (s->two_byte_p)
1475 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1476 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1477 else
1478 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1479 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1481 else
1483 if (s->two_byte_p)
1484 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1485 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1486 else
1487 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1488 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1491 if (s->face->overstrike)
1493 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1494 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1495 if (s->two_byte_p)
1496 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1497 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1498 else
1499 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1500 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1505 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1507 static void
1508 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1509 struct glyph_string *s;
1511 int i, j, x;
1513 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1514 of S to the right of that box line. */
1515 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1516 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1517 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1518 else
1519 x = s->x;
1521 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1522 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1523 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1524 this composition. */
1526 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1527 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1528 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1530 if (s->gidx == 0)
1531 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1532 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1534 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
1535 else if (enable_font_backend)
1537 struct font *font = (struct font *) s->font_info;
1538 int y = s->ybase;
1539 int width = 0;
1541 if (s->cmp->method == COMPOSITION_WITH_GLYPH_STRING)
1543 Lisp_Object gstring = AREF (XHASH_TABLE (composition_hash_table)
1544 ->key_and_value,
1545 s->cmp->hash_index * 2);
1546 int from;
1548 for (i = from = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1550 Lisp_Object g = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1551 Lisp_Object adjustment = LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (g);
1552 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1554 if (! VECTORP (adjustment))
1556 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (g);
1557 continue;
1559 if (from < i)
1561 font->driver->draw (s, from, i, x, y, 0);
1562 x += width;
1564 xoff = XINT (AREF (adjustment, 0));
1565 yoff = XINT (AREF (adjustment, 1));
1566 wadjust = XINT (AREF (adjustment, 2));
1568 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1569 x += wadjust;
1570 from = i + 1;
1571 width = 0;
1573 if (from < i)
1574 font->driver->draw (s, from, i, x, y, 0);
1576 else
1578 for (i = 0, j = s->gidx; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1579 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1581 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1582 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1584 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1585 if (s->face->overstrike)
1586 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1590 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
1591 else
1593 for (i = 0, j = s->gidx; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1594 if (s->face)
1596 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1597 x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2],
1598 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1],
1599 s->char2b + j, 1);
1600 if (s->face->overstrike)
1601 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1602 x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2] + 1,
1603 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1],
1604 s->char2b + j, 1);
1610 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1612 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1613 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1614 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1615 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1616 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1619 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1620 cannot be determined. */
1622 static struct frame *
1623 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1624 Widget widget;
1626 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1627 Lisp_Object tail;
1628 struct frame *f;
1630 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1632 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1633 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1634 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1635 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1636 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1637 widget = XtParent (widget);
1639 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1640 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1641 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1642 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1643 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1644 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1645 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1646 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1647 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1648 return f;
1650 abort ();
1654 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1655 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1656 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1657 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1660 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1661 Widget widget;
1662 Colormap cmap;
1663 XColor *color;
1665 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1666 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1670 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1671 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1672 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1673 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1674 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1675 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1678 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1679 Widget widget;
1680 Display *display;
1681 Colormap cmap;
1682 unsigned long *pixel;
1683 double factor;
1684 int delta;
1686 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1687 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1691 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1692 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1694 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1696 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1697 sizeof (Screen *)},
1698 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1699 sizeof (Colormap)}
1703 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1704 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1706 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1709 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1711 DPY is the display we are working on.
1713 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1714 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1715 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1716 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1718 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1719 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1721 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1722 we allocated the color or not.
1724 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1726 static Boolean
1727 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1728 Display *dpy;
1729 XrmValue *args;
1730 Cardinal *nargs;
1731 XrmValue *from, *to;
1732 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1734 Screen *screen;
1735 Colormap cmap;
1736 Pixel pixel;
1737 String color_name;
1738 XColor color;
1740 if (*nargs != 2)
1742 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1743 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1744 "XtToolkitError",
1745 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1746 return False;
1749 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1750 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1751 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1753 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1755 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1756 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1758 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1760 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1761 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1763 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1764 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1766 pixel = color.pixel;
1767 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1769 else
1771 String params[1];
1772 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1774 params[0] = color_name;
1775 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1776 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1777 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1778 params, &nparams);
1779 return False;
1782 if (to->addr != NULL)
1784 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1786 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1787 return False;
1790 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1792 else
1794 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1795 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1798 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1799 return True;
1803 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1804 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1805 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1807 APP is the application context in which we work.
1809 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1810 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1811 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1813 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1815 static void
1816 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1817 XtAppContext app;
1818 XrmValuePtr to;
1819 XtPointer closure;
1820 XrmValuePtr args;
1821 Cardinal *nargs;
1823 if (*nargs != 2)
1825 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1826 "XtToolkitError",
1827 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1828 NULL, NULL);
1830 else if (closure != NULL)
1832 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1833 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1834 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1835 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1836 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1841 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1844 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1845 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1846 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1847 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1849 static const XColor *
1850 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1851 Display *dpy;
1852 int *ncells;
1854 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1856 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1858 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1859 int i;
1861 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1862 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1863 dpyinfo->color_cells
1864 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1865 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1867 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1868 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1870 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1871 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1874 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1875 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1879 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1880 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1882 void
1883 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1884 struct frame *f;
1885 XColor *colors;
1886 int ncolors;
1888 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1890 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1892 int i;
1893 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1895 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1896 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1897 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1898 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1901 else
1902 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1906 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1907 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1909 void
1910 x_query_color (f, color)
1911 struct frame *f;
1912 XColor *color;
1914 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1918 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1919 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1920 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1921 allocated. */
1923 static int
1924 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1925 Display *dpy;
1926 Colormap cmap;
1927 XColor *color;
1929 int rc;
1931 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1932 if (rc == 0)
1934 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1935 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1936 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1937 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1938 int nearest, i;
1939 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1940 int ncells;
1941 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1943 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1945 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1946 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1947 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1948 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1950 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1952 nearest = i;
1953 nearest_delta = delta;
1957 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1958 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1959 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1960 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1962 else
1964 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1965 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1966 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1967 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1968 XColor *cached_color;
1970 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1971 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1972 (cached_color->red != color->red
1973 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1974 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1976 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1977 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1978 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1982 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1983 if (rc)
1984 register_color (color->pixel);
1985 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1987 return rc;
1991 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1992 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1993 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1994 allocated. */
1997 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1998 struct frame *f;
1999 Colormap cmap;
2000 XColor *color;
2002 gamma_correct (f, color);
2003 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
2007 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
2008 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
2009 get color reference counts right. */
2011 unsigned long
2012 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
2013 struct frame *f;
2014 unsigned long pixel;
2016 XColor color;
2018 color.pixel = pixel;
2019 BLOCK_INPUT;
2020 x_query_color (f, &color);
2021 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
2022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2023 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
2024 register_color (pixel);
2025 #endif
2026 return color.pixel;
2030 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
2031 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
2032 get color reference counts right. */
2034 unsigned long
2035 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
2036 Display *dpy;
2037 Colormap cmap;
2038 unsigned long pixel;
2040 XColor color;
2042 color.pixel = pixel;
2043 BLOCK_INPUT;
2044 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
2045 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
2046 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2047 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
2048 register_color (pixel);
2049 #endif
2050 return color.pixel;
2054 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
2055 boosted.
2057 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
2058 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
2059 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
2060 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
2061 use an additional additive factor.
2063 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
2064 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
2065 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
2068 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
2069 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
2070 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
2071 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
2072 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
2073 Value is non-zero if successful. */
2075 static int
2076 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
2077 struct frame *f;
2078 Display *display;
2079 Colormap cmap;
2080 unsigned long *pixel;
2081 double factor;
2082 int delta;
2084 XColor color, new;
2085 long bright;
2086 int success_p;
2088 /* Get RGB color values. */
2089 color.pixel = *pixel;
2090 x_query_color (f, &color);
2092 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
2093 xassert (factor >= 0);
2094 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
2095 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
2096 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
2098 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
2099 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
2101 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
2102 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
2103 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
2104 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
2105 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
2107 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
2108 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
2109 /* The additive adjustment. */
2110 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
2112 if (factor < 1)
2114 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
2115 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
2116 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
2118 else
2120 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
2121 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
2122 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
2126 /* Try to allocate the color. */
2127 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
2128 if (success_p)
2130 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
2132 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
2133 delta to the RGB values. */
2134 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
2136 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
2137 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
2138 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
2139 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
2141 else
2142 success_p = 1;
2143 *pixel = new.pixel;
2146 return success_p;
2150 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
2151 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
2152 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
2153 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
2154 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
2155 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
2157 static void
2158 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
2159 struct frame *f;
2160 struct relief *relief;
2161 double factor;
2162 int delta;
2163 unsigned long default_pixel;
2165 XGCValues xgcv;
2166 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
2167 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
2168 unsigned long pixel;
2169 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
2170 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
2171 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
2172 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2174 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2175 xgcv.line_width = 1;
2177 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
2178 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
2179 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
2180 if (relief->gc
2181 && relief->allocated_p)
2183 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
2184 relief->allocated_p = 0;
2187 /* Allocate new color. */
2188 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
2189 pixel = background;
2190 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
2191 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
2193 relief->allocated_p = 1;
2194 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
2197 if (relief->gc == 0)
2199 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
2200 mask |= GCStipple;
2201 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
2203 else
2204 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2208 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
2210 static void
2211 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
2212 struct glyph_string *s;
2214 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
2215 unsigned long color;
2217 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
2218 color = s->face->box_color;
2219 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
2220 && s->img->pixmap
2221 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
2222 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
2223 else
2225 XGCValues xgcv;
2227 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2228 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2229 color = xgcv.background;
2232 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2233 || color != di->relief_background)
2235 di->relief_background = color;
2236 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2237 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2238 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2239 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2244 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2245 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2246 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2247 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2248 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2249 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2250 when drawing. */
2252 static void
2253 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2254 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2255 struct frame *f;
2256 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2257 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2258 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2260 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2261 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2262 int i;
2263 GC gc;
2265 if (raised_p)
2266 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2267 else
2268 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2269 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2271 /* Top. */
2272 if (top_p)
2273 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2274 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2275 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2276 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2278 /* Left. */
2279 if (left_p)
2280 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2281 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2282 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2284 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2285 if (raised_p)
2286 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2287 else
2288 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2289 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2291 /* Bottom. */
2292 if (bot_p)
2293 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2294 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2295 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2296 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2298 /* Right. */
2299 if (right_p)
2300 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2301 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2302 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2304 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2308 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2309 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2310 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2311 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2312 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2313 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2315 static void
2316 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2317 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2318 struct glyph_string *s;
2319 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2320 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2322 XGCValues xgcv;
2324 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2325 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2326 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2328 /* Top. */
2329 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2330 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2332 /* Left. */
2333 if (left_p)
2334 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2335 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2337 /* Bottom. */
2338 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2339 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2341 /* Right. */
2342 if (right_p)
2343 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2344 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2346 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2347 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2351 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2353 static void
2354 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2355 struct glyph_string *s;
2357 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2358 int left_p, right_p;
2359 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2360 XRectangle clip_rect;
2362 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2363 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2364 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2366 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2367 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2368 ? s->first_glyph
2369 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2371 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2372 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2373 left_x = s->x;
2374 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2375 ? last_x - 1
2376 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2377 top_y = s->y;
2378 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2380 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2381 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2382 && (s->prev == NULL
2383 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2384 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2385 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2386 && (s->next == NULL
2387 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2389 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2391 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2392 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2393 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2394 else
2396 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2397 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2398 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2403 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2405 static void
2406 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2407 struct glyph_string *s;
2409 int x = s->x;
2410 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2412 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2413 right of that line. */
2414 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2415 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2416 && s->slice.x == 0)
2417 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2419 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2420 by that margin. */
2421 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2422 x += s->img->hmargin;
2423 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2424 y += s->img->vmargin;
2426 if (s->img->pixmap)
2428 if (s->img->mask)
2430 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2431 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2432 trust on the shape extension to be available
2433 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2434 manually. */
2435 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2436 | GCFunction);
2437 XGCValues xgcv;
2438 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2440 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2441 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2442 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2443 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2444 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2446 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2447 image_rect.x = x;
2448 image_rect.y = y;
2449 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2450 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2451 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2452 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2453 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2454 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2456 else
2458 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2460 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2461 image_rect.x = x;
2462 image_rect.y = y;
2463 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2464 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2465 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2466 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2467 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2468 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2470 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2471 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2472 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2473 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2474 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2475 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2476 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2478 int r = s->img->relief;
2479 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2480 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2481 x - r, y - r,
2482 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2483 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2487 else
2488 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2489 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2490 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2494 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2496 static void
2497 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2498 struct glyph_string *s;
2500 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2501 XRectangle r;
2502 int x = s->x;
2503 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2505 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2506 right of that line. */
2507 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2508 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2509 && s->slice.x == 0)
2510 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2512 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2513 by that margin. */
2514 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2515 x += s->img->hmargin;
2516 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2517 y += s->img->vmargin;
2519 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2520 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2522 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2523 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2525 else
2527 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2528 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2531 x0 = x - thick;
2532 y0 = y - thick;
2533 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2534 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2536 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2537 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2538 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2539 s->slice.y == 0,
2540 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2541 s->slice.x == 0,
2542 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2543 &r);
2547 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2549 static void
2550 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2551 struct glyph_string *s;
2552 Pixmap pixmap;
2554 int x = 0;
2555 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2557 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2558 right of that line. */
2559 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2560 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2561 && s->slice.x == 0)
2562 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2564 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2565 by that margin. */
2566 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2567 x += s->img->hmargin;
2568 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2569 y += s->img->vmargin;
2571 if (s->img->pixmap)
2573 if (s->img->mask)
2575 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2576 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2577 trust on the shape extension to be available
2578 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2579 manually. */
2580 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2581 | GCFunction);
2582 XGCValues xgcv;
2584 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2585 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2586 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2587 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2588 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2590 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2591 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2592 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2593 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2595 else
2597 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2598 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2599 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2601 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2602 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2603 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2604 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2605 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2606 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2607 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2609 int r = s->img->relief;
2610 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2611 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2612 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2613 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2617 else
2618 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2619 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2620 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2624 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2625 give the rectangle to draw. */
2627 static void
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2629 struct glyph_string *s;
2630 int x, y, w, h;
2632 if (s->stippled_p)
2634 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2635 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2636 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2637 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2639 else
2640 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2644 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2646 s->y
2647 s->x +-------------------------
2648 | s->face->box
2650 | +-------------------------
2651 | | s->img->margin
2653 | | +-------------------
2654 | | | the image
2658 static void
2659 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2660 struct glyph_string *s;
2662 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2663 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2664 int height;
2665 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2667 height = s->height;
2668 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2669 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2670 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2671 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2673 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2674 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2675 flickering. */
2676 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2677 if (height > s->slice.height
2678 || s->img->hmargin
2679 || s->img->vmargin
2680 || s->img->mask
2681 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2682 || s->width != s->background_width)
2684 if (s->img->mask)
2686 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2687 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2688 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2689 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2690 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2692 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2693 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2694 s->background_width,
2695 s->height, depth);
2697 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2698 pixmap. */
2699 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2701 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2702 if (s->stippled_p)
2704 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2705 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2706 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2707 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2708 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2709 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2710 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2712 else
2714 XGCValues xgcv;
2715 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2716 &xgcv);
2717 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2718 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2719 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2723 else
2725 int x = s->x;
2726 int y = s->y;
2728 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2729 && s->slice.x == 0)
2730 x += box_line_hwidth;
2732 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2733 y += box_line_vwidth;
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2738 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2741 /* Draw the foreground. */
2742 if (pixmap != None)
2744 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2745 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2746 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2747 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2748 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2750 else
2751 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2753 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2754 if (s->img->relief
2755 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2756 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2757 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2761 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2763 static void
2764 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2765 struct glyph_string *s;
2767 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2769 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2770 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2772 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2773 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2774 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2775 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2777 if (x < left_x)
2779 background_width -= left_x - x;
2780 x = left_x;
2782 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2784 /* Draw cursor. */
2785 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2787 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2788 if (width < background_width)
2790 int y = s->y;
2791 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2792 XRectangle r;
2793 GC gc;
2795 x += width;
2796 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2797 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2799 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2800 gc = s->gc;
2802 else
2803 gc = s->face->gc;
2805 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2806 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2808 if (s->face->stipple)
2810 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2811 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2812 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2813 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2815 else
2817 XGCValues xgcv;
2818 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2819 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2820 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2821 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2825 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2827 int background_width = s->background_width;
2828 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2830 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2831 except for header line and mode line. */
2832 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2834 background_width -= left_x - x;
2835 x = left_x;
2837 if (background_width > 0)
2838 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2841 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2845 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2847 static void
2848 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2849 struct glyph_string *s;
2851 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2853 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2854 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2855 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2856 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2858 int width;
2859 struct glyph_string *next;
2861 for (width = 0, next = s->next; next;
2862 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2863 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2865 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2866 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2867 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2868 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
2869 next->num_clips = 0;
2870 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
2874 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2875 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2877 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2878 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2879 if (!s->for_overlaps
2880 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2881 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2882 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2885 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2886 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2887 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2888 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2889 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2891 else if ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2892 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang))
2893 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2894 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2895 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2896 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2897 else
2898 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2900 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2902 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2903 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2904 break;
2906 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2907 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2908 break;
2910 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2911 if (s->for_overlaps)
2912 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2913 else
2914 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2915 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2916 break;
2918 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2919 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2920 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2921 else
2922 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2923 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2924 break;
2926 default:
2927 abort ();
2930 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2932 /* Draw underline. */
2933 if (s->face->underline_p)
2935 unsigned long tem, h;
2936 int y;
2938 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2939 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
2940 if (enable_font_backend)
2941 /* In the future, we must use information of font. */
2942 h = 1;
2943 else
2944 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
2945 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2946 h = 1;
2948 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
2949 if (enable_font_backend)
2951 if (s->face->font)
2952 /* In the future, we must use information of font. */
2953 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2954 else
2955 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2957 else
2958 #endif
2960 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2961 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line)
2963 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2964 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2965 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2966 specs, and its default is
2968 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2969 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2971 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2972 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2973 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2974 else if (s->face->font)
2975 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2979 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2980 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2981 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2982 else
2984 XGCValues xgcv;
2985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2986 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2987 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2988 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2989 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2993 /* Draw overline. */
2994 if (s->face->overline_p)
2996 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2998 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2999 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3000 s->background_width, h);
3001 else
3003 XGCValues xgcv;
3004 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3005 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
3006 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3007 s->background_width, h);
3008 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3012 /* Draw strike-through. */
3013 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
3015 unsigned long h = 1;
3016 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
3018 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
3019 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3020 s->width, h);
3021 else
3023 XGCValues xgcv;
3024 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3025 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
3026 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3027 s->width, h);
3028 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3032 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
3033 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
3034 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
3036 if (s->prev)
3038 struct glyph_string *prev;
3040 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
3041 if (prev->hl != s->hl
3042 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
3044 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
3045 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
3046 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
3048 prev->hl = s->hl;
3049 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
3050 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
3051 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3052 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
3053 else
3054 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
3055 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
3056 prev->hl = save;
3057 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
3058 prev->num_clips = 0;
3059 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
3063 if (s->next)
3065 struct glyph_string *next;
3067 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
3068 if (next->hl != s->hl
3069 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
3071 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
3072 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
3073 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
3075 next->hl = s->hl;
3076 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
3077 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
3078 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3079 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
3080 else
3081 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
3082 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
3083 next->hl = save;
3084 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
3085 next->num_clips = 0;
3086 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
3091 /* Reset clipping. */
3092 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3093 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
3094 s->num_clips = 0;
3095 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
3098 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3100 void
3101 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
3102 struct frame *f;
3103 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3106 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3107 x, y, width, height,
3108 x + shift_by, y);
3111 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3112 for X frames. */
3114 static void
3115 x_delete_glyphs (f, n)
3116 struct frame *f;
3117 register int n;
3119 abort ();
3123 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3124 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3126 void
3127 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
3128 Display *dpy;
3129 Window window;
3130 int x, y;
3131 int width, height;
3132 int exposures;
3134 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3135 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3139 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3141 static void
3142 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3144 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3145 longer visible. */
3146 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3147 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3148 output_cursor.x = -1;
3150 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3151 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3152 BLOCK_INPUT;
3153 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3155 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
3156 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
3157 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3159 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3161 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3166 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3168 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
3169 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
3171 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3174 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
3175 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
3177 static int
3178 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
3179 struct timeval *result, x, y;
3181 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3182 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3183 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3185 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3186 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3187 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3190 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3192 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3193 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3194 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3197 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3198 positive. */
3199 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3200 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3202 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3203 negative. */
3204 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3207 void
3208 XTflash (f)
3209 struct frame *f;
3211 BLOCK_INPUT;
3214 GC gc;
3216 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3217 pixels into background pixels. */
3219 XGCValues values;
3221 values.function = GXxor;
3222 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3223 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3225 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3226 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3230 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3231 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3232 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3233 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3234 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3235 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3236 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3238 int width;
3240 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3241 edge it is next to. */
3242 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3244 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3245 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3246 break;
3248 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3249 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3250 break;
3252 default:
3253 break;
3256 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3258 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3259 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3261 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3262 flash_left,
3263 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3264 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3265 width, flash_height);
3266 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3267 flash_left,
3268 (height - flash_height
3269 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3270 width, flash_height);
3272 else
3273 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3274 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3275 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3276 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3278 x_flush (f);
3281 struct timeval wakeup;
3283 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3285 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3286 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3287 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3288 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3290 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3291 available. */
3292 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3294 struct timeval current;
3295 struct timeval timeout;
3297 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3299 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3300 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3301 break;
3303 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3304 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3305 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3307 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3308 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3312 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3313 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3315 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3316 flash_left,
3317 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3318 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3319 width, flash_height);
3320 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3321 flash_left,
3322 (height - flash_height
3323 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3324 width, flash_height);
3326 else
3327 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3328 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3329 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3330 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3332 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3333 x_flush (f);
3337 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3340 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3343 /* Make audible bell. */
3345 void
3346 XTring_bell ()
3348 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3350 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3352 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3353 if (visible_bell)
3354 XTflash (f);
3355 else
3356 #endif
3358 BLOCK_INPUT;
3359 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3361 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3367 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3368 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3369 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3370 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3372 static void
3373 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3374 register int n;
3376 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3381 /***********************************************************************
3382 Line Dance
3383 ***********************************************************************/
3385 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3386 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3388 static void
3389 x_ins_del_lines (f, vpos, n)
3390 struct frame *f;
3391 int vpos, n;
3393 abort ();
3397 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3399 static void
3400 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3401 struct window *w;
3402 struct run *run;
3404 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3405 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3407 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3408 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3409 fringe of W. */
3410 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3412 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3413 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3414 bottom_y = y + height;
3416 if (to_y < from_y)
3418 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3419 line at the bottom. */
3420 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3421 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3422 else
3423 height = run->height;
3425 else
3427 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3428 at the bottom. */
3429 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3430 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3431 else
3432 height = run->height;
3435 BLOCK_INPUT;
3437 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3438 updated_window = w;
3439 x_clear_cursor (w);
3441 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3442 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3443 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3444 x, from_y,
3445 width, height,
3446 x, to_y);
3448 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3453 /***********************************************************************
3454 Exposure Events
3455 ***********************************************************************/
3458 static void
3459 frame_highlight (f)
3460 struct frame *f;
3462 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3463 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3464 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3465 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3466 BLOCK_INPUT;
3467 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3468 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3470 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3473 static void
3474 frame_unhighlight (f)
3475 struct frame *f;
3477 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3478 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3479 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3480 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3481 BLOCK_INPUT;
3482 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3483 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3484 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3485 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3488 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3489 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3490 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3491 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3492 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3494 static void
3495 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3496 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3497 struct frame *frame;
3499 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3501 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3503 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3504 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3505 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3507 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3508 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3510 #if 0
3511 selected_frame = frame;
3512 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3513 selected_frame);
3514 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3515 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3516 #endif /* ! 0 */
3518 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3519 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3520 else
3521 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3524 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3527 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3528 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3529 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3531 static void
3532 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3533 int type;
3534 int state;
3535 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3536 struct frame *frame;
3537 struct input_event *bufp;
3539 if (type == FocusIn)
3541 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3543 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3544 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3546 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3547 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3548 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3549 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3550 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3552 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3553 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3557 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3559 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3560 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3561 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3562 #endif
3564 else if (type == FocusOut)
3566 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3568 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3570 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3571 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3574 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3575 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3576 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3577 #endif
3581 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3582 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3584 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3586 static void
3587 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3588 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3589 XEvent *event;
3590 struct input_event *bufp;
3592 struct frame *frame;
3594 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3595 if (! frame)
3596 return;
3598 switch (event->type)
3600 case EnterNotify:
3601 case LeaveNotify:
3603 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3604 int focus_state
3605 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3607 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3608 && event->xcrossing.focus
3609 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3610 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3611 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3612 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3614 break;
3616 case FocusIn:
3617 case FocusOut:
3618 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3619 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3620 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3621 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3622 break;
3624 case ClientMessage:
3625 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3627 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3628 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3629 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3631 break;
3636 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3638 void
3639 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3640 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3642 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3645 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3646 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3647 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3649 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3650 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3651 the appropriate X display info. */
3653 static void
3654 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3655 struct frame *frame;
3657 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3660 static void
3661 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3664 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3666 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3668 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3669 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3670 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3671 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3672 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3674 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3675 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3678 else
3679 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3681 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3683 if (old_highlight)
3684 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3685 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3686 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3692 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3694 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3695 static void
3696 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3697 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3699 int min_code, max_code;
3700 KeySym *syms;
3701 int syms_per_code;
3702 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3704 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3705 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3706 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3707 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3708 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3710 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3712 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3713 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3714 &syms_per_code);
3715 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3717 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3718 Alt keysyms are on. */
3720 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3721 int found_alt_or_meta;
3723 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3725 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3726 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3728 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3730 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3731 if (code == 0)
3732 continue;
3734 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3736 int code_col;
3738 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3740 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3742 switch (sym)
3744 case XK_Meta_L:
3745 case XK_Meta_R:
3746 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3747 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3748 break;
3750 case XK_Alt_L:
3751 case XK_Alt_R:
3752 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3753 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3754 break;
3756 case XK_Hyper_L:
3757 case XK_Hyper_R:
3758 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3759 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3760 code_col = syms_per_code;
3761 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3762 break;
3764 case XK_Super_L:
3765 case XK_Super_R:
3766 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3767 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3768 code_col = syms_per_code;
3769 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3770 break;
3772 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3773 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3774 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3775 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3776 code_col = syms_per_code;
3777 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3778 break;
3786 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3787 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3789 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3790 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3793 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3794 make them just meta, not alt. */
3795 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3797 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3800 XFree ((char *) syms);
3801 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3804 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3805 Emacs uses. */
3807 unsigned int
3808 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3809 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3810 unsigned int state;
3812 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3813 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3814 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3815 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3816 Lisp_Object tem;
3818 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3819 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3820 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3821 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3822 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3823 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3824 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3825 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3828 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3829 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3830 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3831 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3832 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3833 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3836 static unsigned int
3837 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3838 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3839 unsigned int state;
3841 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3842 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3843 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3844 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3846 Lisp_Object tem;
3848 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3849 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3850 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3851 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3852 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3853 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3854 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3855 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3858 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3859 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3860 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3861 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3862 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3863 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3866 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3868 char *
3869 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3870 KeySym keysym;
3872 char *value;
3874 BLOCK_INPUT;
3875 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3878 return value;
3883 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3885 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3887 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3888 the mouse. */
3890 static Lisp_Object
3891 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3892 struct input_event *result;
3893 XButtonEvent *event;
3894 struct frame *f;
3896 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3897 otherwise. */
3898 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3899 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3900 result->timestamp = event->time;
3901 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3902 event->state)
3903 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3904 ? up_modifier
3905 : down_modifier));
3907 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3908 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3909 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3910 result->arg = Qnil;
3911 return Qnil;
3915 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3916 The input handler calls this.
3918 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3919 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3920 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3921 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3923 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3924 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3926 static int
3927 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3928 FRAME_PTR frame;
3929 XMotionEvent *event;
3931 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3932 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3933 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3935 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3936 return 0;
3938 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3940 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3941 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3942 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3943 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3944 return 1;
3948 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3949 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3950 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3951 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3952 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3953 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3955 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3956 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3957 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3958 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3959 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3960 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3961 return 1;
3964 return 0;
3968 /************************************************************************
3969 Mouse Face
3970 ************************************************************************/
3972 static void
3973 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3975 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3976 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3977 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3978 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3979 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3984 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3985 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3987 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3988 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3989 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3990 position on the scroll bar.
3992 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3993 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3994 the mouse is over.
3996 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3997 was at this position.
3999 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
4001 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
4002 movement. */
4004 static void
4005 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
4006 FRAME_PTR *fp;
4007 int insist;
4008 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
4009 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
4010 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
4011 unsigned long *time;
4013 FRAME_PTR f1;
4015 BLOCK_INPUT;
4017 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
4018 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
4019 else
4021 Window root;
4022 int root_x, root_y;
4024 Window dummy_window;
4025 int dummy;
4027 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
4029 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
4030 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4031 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
4032 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
4033 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
4035 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4037 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4038 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4039 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
4041 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4042 &root,
4044 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4045 a different screen. */
4046 &dummy_window,
4048 /* The position on that root window. */
4049 &root_x, &root_y,
4051 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4052 &dummy, &dummy,
4054 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4055 we don't care. */
4056 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
4058 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4059 containing the pointer. */
4061 Window win, child;
4062 int win_x, win_y;
4063 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
4065 win = root;
4067 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4068 structure is changing at the same time this function
4069 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4071 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
4073 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
4074 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
4076 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4077 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4078 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4080 /* From-window, to-window. */
4081 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
4083 /* From-position, to-position. */
4084 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4086 /* Child of win. */
4087 &child);
4088 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
4090 else
4092 while (1)
4094 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4096 /* From-window, to-window. */
4097 root, win,
4099 /* From-position, to-position. */
4100 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4102 /* Child of win. */
4103 &child);
4105 if (child == None || child == win)
4106 break;
4108 win = child;
4109 parent_x = win_x;
4110 parent_y = win_y;
4113 /* Now we know that:
4114 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4115 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4116 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4117 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4118 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4119 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4120 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4121 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4122 never use them in that case.) */
4124 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4125 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4127 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4128 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4129 on the frame. */
4130 if (f1 != NULL
4131 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4132 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4133 f1 = NULL;
4134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4137 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4138 f1 = 0;
4140 x_uncatch_errors ();
4142 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4143 if (! f1)
4145 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4147 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4149 if (bar)
4151 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4152 win_x = parent_x;
4153 win_y = parent_y;
4157 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4158 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4160 if (f1)
4162 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4163 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4164 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4165 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4166 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4167 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4168 the frame are divided into. */
4170 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4171 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4173 *bar_window = Qnil;
4174 *part = 0;
4175 *fp = f1;
4176 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4177 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4178 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
4183 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4188 /***********************************************************************
4189 Scroll bars
4190 ***********************************************************************/
4192 /* Scroll bar support. */
4194 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4195 manages it.
4196 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4197 bits. */
4199 static struct scroll_bar *
4200 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
4201 Display *display;
4202 Window window_id;
4204 Lisp_Object tail;
4206 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4207 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4208 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4210 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4212 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4214 frame = XCAR (tail);
4215 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4216 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4217 abort ();
4219 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4220 continue;
4222 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4223 right window ID. */
4224 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4225 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4226 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4227 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4228 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4229 condemned = Qnil,
4230 ! NILP (bar));
4231 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4232 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4233 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4234 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4237 return 0;
4241 #if defined USE_LUCID
4243 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4244 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4246 static Widget
4247 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
4248 Window window;
4250 Lisp_Object tail;
4252 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4254 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4256 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4257 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4259 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4260 return menu_bar;
4264 return NULL;
4267 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4270 /************************************************************************
4271 Toolkit scroll bars
4272 ************************************************************************/
4274 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4276 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
4277 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
4278 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
4279 struct scroll_bar *));
4280 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4281 int, int, int));
4284 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4285 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4287 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4289 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4291 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4293 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4294 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4296 #ifndef USE_GTK
4297 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4299 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4301 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4303 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4304 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4305 to avoid jerkyness. */
4307 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4309 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4310 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4311 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4312 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4314 static void
4315 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4316 num_params)
4317 Widget widget;
4318 XtPointer client_data;
4319 String action_name;
4320 XEvent *event;
4321 String *params;
4322 Cardinal *num_params;
4324 int scroll_bar_p;
4325 char *end_action;
4327 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4328 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4329 end_action = "Release";
4330 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4331 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4332 end_action = "EndScroll";
4333 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4335 if (scroll_bar_p
4336 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4337 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4339 struct window *w;
4341 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4342 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4343 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4345 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4347 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4348 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4349 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4351 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4352 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4354 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4355 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4358 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4360 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4361 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4363 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4364 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4367 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4368 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4369 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4370 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4372 static void
4373 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4374 Lisp_Object window;
4375 int part, portion, whole;
4377 XEvent event;
4378 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4379 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4380 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4381 int i;
4383 BLOCK_INPUT;
4385 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4386 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4387 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4388 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4389 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4390 ev->format = 32;
4392 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4393 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4394 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4395 into that array in the event. */
4396 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4397 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4398 break;
4400 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4402 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4403 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4404 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4406 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4407 nbytes);
4408 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4409 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4412 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4413 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4414 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4415 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4416 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4417 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4419 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4420 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4421 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4422 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4423 #endif
4425 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4426 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4427 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4428 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4429 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4433 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4434 in *IEVENT. */
4436 static void
4437 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4438 XEvent *event;
4439 struct input_event *ievent;
4441 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4442 Lisp_Object window;
4443 struct frame *f;
4444 struct window *w;
4446 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4447 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4449 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4450 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4452 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4453 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4454 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4455 #ifdef USE_GTK
4456 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4457 #else
4458 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4459 #endif
4460 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4461 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4462 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4463 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4464 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4468 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4470 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4472 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4475 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4476 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4477 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4479 static void
4480 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4481 Widget widget;
4482 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4484 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4485 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4486 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4488 switch (cs->reason)
4490 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4491 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4492 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4493 break;
4495 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4496 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4497 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4498 break;
4500 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4501 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4502 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4503 break;
4505 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4506 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4507 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4508 break;
4510 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4511 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4512 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4513 break;
4515 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4516 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4517 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4518 break;
4520 case XmCR_DRAG:
4522 int slider_size;
4524 /* Get the slider size. */
4525 BLOCK_INPUT;
4526 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4529 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4530 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4531 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4532 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4534 break;
4536 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4537 break;
4540 if (part >= 0)
4542 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4543 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4544 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4548 #elif defined USE_GTK
4550 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4551 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4553 static void
4554 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4555 GtkRange *widget;
4556 gpointer data;
4558 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4559 gdouble previous;
4560 gdouble position;
4561 gdouble *p;
4562 int diff;
4564 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4565 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4567 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4569 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4570 if (! p)
4572 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4573 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4574 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4577 previous = *p;
4578 *p = position;
4580 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4582 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4584 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4586 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4587 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4589 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4591 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4592 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4594 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4596 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4597 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4599 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4601 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4602 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4604 else
4606 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4607 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4608 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4609 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4612 if (part >= 0)
4614 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4615 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4616 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4620 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4622 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4623 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4624 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4625 the thumb is. */
4627 static void
4628 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4629 Widget widget;
4630 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4632 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4633 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4634 float shown;
4635 int whole, portion, height;
4636 int part;
4638 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4639 BLOCK_INPUT;
4640 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4641 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4643 whole = 10000000;
4644 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4646 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4647 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4648 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4649 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4650 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4651 bottom). */
4652 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4653 else
4654 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4656 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4657 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4658 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4659 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4663 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4664 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4665 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4666 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4667 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4668 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4669 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4671 static void
4672 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4673 Widget widget;
4674 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4676 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4677 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4678 int position = (long) call_data;
4679 Dimension height;
4680 int part;
4682 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4683 BLOCK_INPUT;
4684 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4687 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4688 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4690 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4691 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4692 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4693 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4694 else
4695 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4697 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4698 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4699 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4700 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4703 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4705 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4707 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4708 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4710 #ifdef USE_GTK
4711 static void
4712 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4713 struct frame *f;
4714 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4716 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4718 BLOCK_INPUT;
4719 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4720 scroll_bar_name);
4721 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4724 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4726 static void
4727 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4728 struct frame *f;
4729 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4731 Window xwindow;
4732 Widget widget;
4733 Arg av[20];
4734 int ac = 0;
4735 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4736 unsigned long pixel;
4738 BLOCK_INPUT;
4740 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4741 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4743 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4744 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4745 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4746 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4747 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4748 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4750 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4751 if (pixel != -1)
4753 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4754 ++ac;
4757 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4758 if (pixel != -1)
4760 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4761 ++ac;
4764 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4765 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4767 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4768 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4769 (XtPointer) bar);
4770 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4771 (XtPointer) bar);
4772 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4773 (XtPointer) bar);
4774 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4775 (XtPointer) bar);
4776 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4777 (XtPointer) bar);
4778 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4779 (XtPointer) bar);
4780 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4781 (XtPointer) bar);
4783 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4784 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4786 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4787 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4788 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4789 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4791 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4793 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4794 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4795 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4796 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4797 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4798 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4799 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4800 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4802 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4803 if (pixel != -1)
4805 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4806 ++ac;
4809 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4810 if (pixel != -1)
4812 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4813 ++ac;
4816 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4818 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4819 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4821 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4822 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4823 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4824 pixel = -1;
4825 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4827 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4829 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4830 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4831 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4832 pixel = -1;
4833 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4836 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4837 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4838 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4839 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4840 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4841 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4843 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4844 ++ac;
4846 else
4847 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4848 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4849 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4851 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4852 the shadows. */
4853 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4854 ++ac;
4856 /* Specify the colors. */
4857 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4858 if (pixel != -1)
4860 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4861 ++ac;
4863 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4864 if (pixel != -1)
4866 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4867 ++ac;
4870 #endif
4872 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4873 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4876 char *initial = "";
4877 char *val = initial;
4878 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4879 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4880 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4881 #endif
4882 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4883 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4884 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4885 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4886 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4887 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4891 /* Define callbacks. */
4892 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4893 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4894 (XtPointer) bar);
4896 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4897 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4899 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4901 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4902 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4903 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4904 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4906 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4907 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4908 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4909 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4911 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4913 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4916 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4917 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4919 #ifdef USE_GTK
4920 static void
4921 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4922 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4923 int portion, position, whole;
4925 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4928 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4929 static void
4930 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4931 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4932 int portion, position, whole;
4934 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4935 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4936 float top, shown;
4938 BLOCK_INPUT;
4940 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4942 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4943 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4944 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4945 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4946 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4947 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4948 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4949 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4950 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4951 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4952 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4953 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4954 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4955 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4956 whole += portion;
4958 if (whole <= 0)
4959 top = 0, shown = 1;
4960 else
4962 top = (float) position / whole;
4963 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4966 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4968 int size, value;
4970 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4971 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4972 value. */
4973 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4974 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4975 size = max (size, 1);
4977 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4978 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4979 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4981 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4983 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4985 if (whole == 0)
4986 top = 0, shown = 1;
4987 else
4989 top = (float) position / whole;
4990 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4994 float old_top, old_shown;
4995 Dimension height;
4996 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4997 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4998 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4999 XtNheight, &height,
5000 NULL);
5002 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5003 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
5004 top = max (0, min (1, top));
5005 else
5006 top = old_top;
5007 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5008 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
5010 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
5011 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
5012 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
5013 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
5015 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5016 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5017 else
5019 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5020 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
5021 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
5023 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5027 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5029 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5031 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5033 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5037 /************************************************************************
5038 Scroll bars, general
5039 ************************************************************************/
5041 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
5042 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
5043 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
5044 scroll bar. */
5046 static struct scroll_bar *
5047 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
5048 struct window *w;
5049 int top, left, width, height;
5051 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5052 struct scroll_bar *bar
5053 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
5055 BLOCK_INPUT;
5057 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5058 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
5059 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5061 XSetWindowAttributes a;
5062 unsigned long mask;
5063 Window window;
5065 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5066 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
5067 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
5069 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
5070 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
5071 | ExposureMask);
5072 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
5074 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
5076 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
5077 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
5078 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
5079 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5080 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5081 left, top, width,
5082 window_box_height (w), False);
5084 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5085 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
5086 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5087 top,
5088 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5089 height,
5090 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5092 CopyFromParent,
5093 CopyFromParent,
5094 CopyFromParent,
5095 /* Attributes. */
5096 mask, &a);
5097 bar->x_window = window;
5099 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5101 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5102 bar->top = top;
5103 bar->left = left;
5104 bar->width = width;
5105 bar->height = height;
5106 bar->start = 0;
5107 bar->end = 0;
5108 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5109 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5111 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5112 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5113 bar->prev = Qnil;
5114 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5115 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5116 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5118 /* Map the window/widget. */
5119 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5121 #ifdef USE_GTK
5122 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5123 bar->x_window,
5124 top,
5125 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5126 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5127 max (height, 1));
5128 xg_show_scroll_bar (bar->x_window);
5129 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5130 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5131 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5132 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5133 top,
5134 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5135 max (height, 1), 0);
5136 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5137 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5139 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5140 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5141 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5143 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5144 return bar;
5148 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5150 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5152 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5153 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5154 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5155 events.)
5157 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5158 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5159 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5160 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5161 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5163 static void
5164 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
5165 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5166 int start, end;
5167 int rebuild;
5169 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5170 Window w = bar->x_window;
5171 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5172 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5174 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5175 if (! rebuild
5176 && start == bar->start
5177 && end == bar->end)
5178 return;
5180 BLOCK_INPUT;
5183 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5184 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5185 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5187 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5188 the distance between start and end. */
5190 int length = end - start;
5192 if (start < 0)
5193 start = 0;
5194 else if (start > top_range)
5195 start = top_range;
5196 end = start + length;
5198 if (end < start)
5199 end = start;
5200 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5201 end = top_range;
5204 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5205 bar->start = start;
5206 bar->end = end;
5208 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5209 if (end > top_range)
5210 end = top_range;
5212 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5213 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5214 that many pixels tall. */
5215 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5217 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5218 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5219 if (0 < start)
5220 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5221 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5222 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5223 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5224 inside_width, start,
5225 False);
5227 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5228 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5229 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5230 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5232 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5233 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5234 /* x, y, width, height */
5235 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5236 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5237 inside_width, end - start);
5239 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5240 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5241 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5242 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5244 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5245 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5246 if (end < inside_height)
5247 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5248 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5249 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5250 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5251 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5252 False);
5256 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5259 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5261 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5262 nil. */
5264 static void
5265 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
5266 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5268 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5269 BLOCK_INPUT;
5271 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5272 #ifdef USE_GTK
5273 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5274 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5275 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5276 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5277 #else
5278 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5279 #endif
5281 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5282 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5284 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5288 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5289 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5290 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5291 create one. */
5293 static void
5294 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5295 struct window *w;
5296 int portion, whole, position;
5298 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5299 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5300 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5301 int window_y, window_height;
5302 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5303 int fringe_extended_p;
5304 #endif
5306 /* Get window dimensions. */
5307 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5308 top = window_y;
5309 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5310 height = window_height;
5312 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5313 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5315 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5316 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5317 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5318 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5319 else
5320 sb_width = width;
5322 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5323 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5324 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5325 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5326 else
5327 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5328 #else
5329 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5330 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5331 else
5332 sb_left = left;
5333 #endif
5335 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5336 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5337 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5338 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5339 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5340 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5341 else
5342 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5343 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5344 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5345 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5346 #endif
5348 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5349 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5351 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5353 BLOCK_INPUT;
5354 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5355 if (fringe_extended_p)
5356 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5357 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5358 else
5359 #endif
5360 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5361 left, top, width, height, False);
5362 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5365 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5367 else
5369 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5370 unsigned int mask = 0;
5372 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5374 BLOCK_INPUT;
5376 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5377 mask |= CWX;
5378 if (top != bar->top)
5379 mask |= CWY;
5380 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5381 mask |= CWWidth;
5382 if (height != bar->height)
5383 mask |= CWHeight;
5385 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5387 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5388 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5390 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5391 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5392 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5394 if (fringe_extended_p)
5395 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5396 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5397 else
5398 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5399 left, top, width, height, False);
5401 #ifdef USE_GTK
5402 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5403 bar->x_window,
5404 top,
5405 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5406 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5407 max (height, 1));
5408 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5409 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5410 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5411 top,
5412 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5413 max (height, 1), 0);
5414 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5416 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5418 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5419 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5420 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5422 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5423 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5424 height, False);
5425 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5426 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5427 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5428 height, False);
5431 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5432 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5433 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5434 example. */
5436 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5437 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5438 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5440 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5441 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5442 left + area_width - rest, top,
5443 rest, height, False);
5444 else
5445 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5446 left, top, rest, height, False);
5450 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5451 if (mask)
5453 XWindowChanges wc;
5455 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5456 wc.y = top;
5457 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5458 wc.height = height;
5459 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5460 mask, &wc);
5463 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5465 /* Remember new settings. */
5466 bar->left = sb_left;
5467 bar->top = top;
5468 bar->width = sb_width;
5469 bar->height = height;
5471 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5474 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5475 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5477 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5478 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5479 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5480 dragged. */
5481 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5483 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5485 if (whole == 0)
5486 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5487 else
5489 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5490 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5491 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5494 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5496 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5500 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5501 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5502 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5503 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5504 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5505 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5506 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5508 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5509 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5510 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5512 static void
5513 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5514 FRAME_PTR frame;
5516 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5517 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5519 Lisp_Object bar;
5520 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5521 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5522 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5523 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5524 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5525 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5526 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5531 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5532 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5534 static void
5535 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5536 struct window *window;
5538 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5539 struct frame *f;
5541 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5542 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5543 abort ();
5545 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5547 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5548 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5549 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5551 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5552 the lists. */
5553 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5554 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5555 return;
5556 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5557 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5558 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5559 else
5560 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5561 one or the other! */
5562 abort ();
5564 else
5565 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5567 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5568 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5570 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5571 bar->prev = Qnil;
5572 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5573 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5574 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5577 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5578 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5580 static void
5581 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5582 FRAME_PTR f;
5584 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5586 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5588 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5589 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5590 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5592 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5594 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5596 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5598 next = b->next;
5599 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5602 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5603 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5607 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5608 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5609 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5611 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5612 mark bits. */
5614 static void
5615 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5616 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5617 XEvent *event;
5619 Window w = bar->x_window;
5620 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5621 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5622 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5624 BLOCK_INPUT;
5626 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5628 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5629 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5630 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5631 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5633 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5634 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5636 /* x, y, width, height */
5637 0, 0,
5638 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5639 bar->height - 1);
5641 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5642 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5643 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5644 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5646 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5649 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5651 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5652 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5654 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5655 mark bits. */
5658 static void
5659 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5660 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5661 XEvent *event;
5662 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5664 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5665 abort ();
5667 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5668 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5669 emacs_event->modifiers
5670 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5671 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5672 event->xbutton.state)
5673 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5674 ? up_modifier
5675 : down_modifier));
5676 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5677 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5678 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5680 #if 0
5681 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5682 int internal_height
5683 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5684 #endif
5685 int top_range
5686 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5687 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5689 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5690 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5692 if (y < bar->start)
5693 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5694 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5695 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5696 else
5697 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5699 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5700 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5701 whether or not we're dragging. */
5702 #if 0
5703 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5704 holding it. */
5705 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5706 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5707 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - bar->start);
5708 #endif
5710 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5711 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5712 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5713 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5715 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5716 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5718 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5719 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5721 #endif
5723 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5724 #if 0
5725 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5726 the handle. */
5727 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5728 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5729 else
5730 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5731 #else
5732 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5733 #endif
5735 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5739 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5741 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5743 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5744 mark bits. */
5746 static void
5747 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5748 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5749 XEvent *event;
5751 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5753 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5755 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5756 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5758 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5759 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5761 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5762 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5764 if (new_start != bar->start)
5766 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5768 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5773 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5775 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5776 on the scroll bar. */
5778 static void
5779 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5780 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5781 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5782 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5783 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5784 unsigned long *time;
5786 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5787 Window w = bar->x_window;
5788 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5789 int win_x, win_y;
5790 Window dummy_window;
5791 int dummy_coord;
5792 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5794 BLOCK_INPUT;
5796 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5797 report that. */
5798 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5800 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5801 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5802 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5804 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5805 &win_x, &win_y,
5807 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5808 &dummy_mask))
5810 else
5812 #if 0
5813 int inside_height
5814 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5815 #endif
5816 int top_range
5817 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5819 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5821 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5822 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5824 if (win_y < 0)
5825 win_y = 0;
5826 if (win_y > top_range)
5827 win_y = top_range;
5829 *fp = f;
5830 *bar_window = bar->window;
5832 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5833 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5834 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5835 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5836 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5837 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5838 else
5839 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5841 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5842 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5844 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5845 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5848 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5850 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5854 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5855 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5856 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5857 redraw them. */
5859 void
5860 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5861 FRAME_PTR f;
5863 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5864 Lisp_Object bar;
5866 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5867 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5868 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5869 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5870 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5871 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5872 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5873 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5874 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5875 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5879 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5881 #if 0
5882 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5883 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5884 sometimes don't work. */
5886 static Time enter_timestamp;
5887 #endif
5889 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5890 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5891 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5892 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5894 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5895 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5897 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5899 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5900 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5902 static int temp_index;
5903 static short temp_buffer[100];
5905 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5906 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5907 temp_index = 0; \
5908 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5910 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5911 on a particular display. */
5913 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5915 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5916 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5917 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5918 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5920 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5922 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5923 do \
5925 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5926 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5927 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5928 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5929 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5930 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5932 while (0)
5934 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5935 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5938 enum
5940 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5941 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5942 X_EVENT_DROP
5945 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5946 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5947 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5949 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5950 this event further.
5951 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5953 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5954 static int
5955 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5956 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5957 XEvent *event;
5959 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5960 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5961 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5962 was created. */
5964 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5965 event->xclient.window);
5967 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5969 #endif
5971 #ifdef USE_GTK
5972 static int current_count;
5973 static int current_finish;
5974 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5976 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5977 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5978 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5979 static GdkFilterReturn
5980 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5981 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5982 GdkEvent *ev;
5983 gpointer data;
5985 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5987 if (current_count >= 0)
5989 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5991 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5993 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5994 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5995 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5996 so we do it here. */
5997 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5998 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5999 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6000 #endif
6002 if (! dpyinfo)
6003 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6004 else
6006 current_count +=
6007 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
6008 current_hold_quit);
6011 else
6012 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
6014 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
6015 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6017 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
6019 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6022 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
6024 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
6025 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
6026 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
6028 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
6030 static int
6031 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
6032 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6033 XEvent *eventp;
6034 int *finish;
6035 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6037 union {
6038 struct input_event ie;
6039 struct selection_input_event sie;
6040 } inev;
6041 int count = 0;
6042 int do_help = 0;
6043 int nbytes = 0;
6044 struct frame *f = NULL;
6045 struct coding_system coding;
6046 XEvent event = *eventp;
6048 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6050 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
6051 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
6052 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
6054 switch (event.type)
6056 case ClientMessage:
6058 if (event.xclient.message_type
6059 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
6060 && event.xclient.format == 32)
6062 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6063 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
6065 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
6066 could be the shell widget window
6067 if the frame has no title bar. */
6068 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6069 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6070 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
6071 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
6072 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
6073 #endif
6074 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
6075 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
6076 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
6077 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
6078 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
6079 needed.
6081 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
6082 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
6083 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
6084 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
6085 Emacs. */
6087 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
6088 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
6089 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
6090 if (f)
6092 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
6093 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
6094 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
6095 x_catch_errors (d);
6096 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
6097 /* The ICCCM says this is
6098 the only valid choice. */
6099 RevertToParent,
6100 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
6101 /* This is needed to detect the error
6102 if there is an error. */
6103 XSync (d, False);
6104 x_uncatch_errors ();
6106 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
6107 #endif /* 0 */
6108 goto done;
6111 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6112 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
6114 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
6115 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
6116 the session manager, who's looking for such a
6117 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
6118 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
6119 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
6120 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
6121 session manager and one for this. */
6122 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6123 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
6124 #endif
6126 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6127 event.xclient.window);
6128 /* This is just so we only give real data once
6129 for a single Emacs process. */
6130 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
6131 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6132 event.xclient.window,
6133 initial_argv, initial_argc);
6134 else if (f)
6135 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6136 event.xclient.window,
6137 0, 0);
6139 goto done;
6142 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6143 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6145 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6146 event.xclient.window);
6147 if (!f)
6148 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6150 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6151 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6152 goto done;
6155 goto done;
6158 if (event.xclient.message_type
6159 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6161 goto done;
6164 if (event.xclient.message_type
6165 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6167 int new_x, new_y;
6168 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6170 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6171 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6173 if (f)
6175 f->left_pos = new_x;
6176 f->top_pos = new_y;
6178 goto done;
6181 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6182 if (event.xclient.message_type
6183 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6185 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6186 if (f)
6187 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6188 &event, NULL);
6189 goto done;
6191 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6193 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6194 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6195 || (event.xclient.message_type
6196 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6198 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6199 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6200 currently never do because we are interested in
6201 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6202 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6203 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6204 if (!f)
6205 goto OTHER;
6206 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6207 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6208 goto done;
6211 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6212 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6213 we construct an input_event. */
6214 if (event.xclient.message_type
6215 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6217 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6218 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6219 goto done;
6221 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6223 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6224 if (event.xclient.message_type
6225 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6227 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6228 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6229 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6231 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6232 goto done;
6235 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6236 if (!f)
6237 goto OTHER;
6238 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6239 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6241 break;
6243 case SelectionNotify:
6244 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6245 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6246 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6247 goto OTHER;
6248 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6249 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6250 break;
6252 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6253 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6254 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6255 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6256 goto OTHER;
6257 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6259 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6261 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6262 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6263 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6264 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6265 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6267 break;
6269 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6270 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6271 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6272 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6273 goto OTHER;
6274 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6276 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6277 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6279 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6280 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6281 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6282 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6283 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6284 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6285 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6286 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6288 break;
6290 case PropertyNotify:
6291 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6292 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
6293 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
6294 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
6295 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6296 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
6297 goto OTHER;
6298 #endif
6299 #endif
6300 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6301 goto OTHER;
6303 case ReparentNotify:
6304 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6305 if (f)
6307 int x, y;
6308 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6309 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6310 f->left_pos = x;
6311 f->top_pos = y;
6313 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6314 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6315 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6317 goto OTHER;
6319 case Expose:
6320 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6321 if (f)
6323 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6325 #ifdef USE_GTK
6326 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6327 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6328 event.xexpose.window,
6329 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6330 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6331 FALSE);
6332 #endif
6333 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6335 f->async_visible = 1;
6336 f->async_iconified = 0;
6337 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6338 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6340 else
6341 expose_frame (f,
6342 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6343 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6345 else
6347 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6348 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6349 #endif
6350 #if defined USE_LUCID
6351 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6352 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6353 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6355 Widget widget
6356 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6357 if (widget)
6358 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6360 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6362 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6363 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6364 goto OTHER;
6365 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6366 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6367 event.xexpose.window);
6369 if (bar)
6370 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6371 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6372 else
6373 goto OTHER;
6374 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6375 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6377 break;
6379 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6380 source area was obscured or not
6381 available. */
6382 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6383 if (f)
6385 expose_frame (f,
6386 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6387 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6388 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6390 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6391 else
6392 goto OTHER;
6393 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6394 break;
6396 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6397 source area was completely
6398 available. */
6399 break;
6401 case UnmapNotify:
6402 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6403 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6405 tip_window = 0;
6406 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6409 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6410 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6411 the frame was deleted. */
6413 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6414 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6415 display that won't ever be seen. */
6416 f->async_visible = 0;
6417 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6418 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6419 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6420 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6421 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6422 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6423 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6425 f->async_iconified = 1;
6427 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6428 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6431 goto OTHER;
6433 case MapNotify:
6434 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6435 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6436 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6437 goto OTHER;
6439 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6440 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6441 frame is visible. */
6442 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6443 if (f)
6445 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6446 the frame's display structures.
6447 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6448 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6449 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6450 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6451 if (! f->async_iconified)
6452 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6454 f->async_visible = 1;
6455 f->async_iconified = 0;
6456 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6458 if (f->iconified)
6460 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6461 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6463 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6464 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6465 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6466 to update the frame titles
6467 in case this is the second frame. */
6468 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6470 goto OTHER;
6472 case KeyPress:
6474 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6475 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6477 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6478 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6479 if (popup_activated ())
6480 goto OTHER;
6481 #endif
6483 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6485 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6486 mouse highlighting. */
6487 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6488 && (f == 0
6489 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6491 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6492 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6495 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6496 if (f == 0)
6498 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6499 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6500 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6501 event.xkey.window);
6502 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6504 widget = XtParent (widget);
6505 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6508 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6510 if (f != 0)
6512 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6513 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6514 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6515 his Emacs hang.
6517 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6518 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6519 status_return even if the input is too long to
6520 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6521 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6522 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6523 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6524 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6525 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6526 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6527 int modifiers;
6528 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6529 Lisp_Object c;
6531 #ifdef USE_GTK
6532 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6533 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6534 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6535 (see above). */
6536 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6537 #endif
6539 event.xkey.state
6540 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6541 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6542 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6544 /* This will have to go some day... */
6546 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6547 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6548 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6549 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6550 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6551 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6552 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6554 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6555 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6556 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6557 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6558 not it is combined with Meta. */
6559 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6560 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6562 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6563 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6565 Status status_return;
6567 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6568 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6569 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6570 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6571 &status_return);
6572 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6574 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6575 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6576 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6577 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6578 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6579 &status_return);
6581 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6582 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6583 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6584 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6585 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6586 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6587 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6588 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6589 &status_return);
6590 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6592 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6593 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6594 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6595 &event.xkey,
6596 copy_bufptr,
6597 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6598 &status_return);
6601 #endif
6603 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6604 break;
6605 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6607 keysym = NoSymbol;
6608 modifiers = 0;
6610 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6611 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6612 abort ();
6614 else
6615 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6616 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6617 &compose_status);
6618 #else
6619 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6620 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6621 &compose_status);
6622 #endif
6624 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6625 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6626 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6627 break;
6629 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6630 orig_keysym = keysym;
6632 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6633 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6634 inev.ie.modifiers
6635 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6636 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6638 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6639 translations to characters. */
6640 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6641 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6643 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6644 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6645 goto done_keysym;
6648 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6649 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6651 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6652 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6653 else
6654 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6655 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6656 goto done_keysym;
6659 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6660 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6661 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6662 Vx_keysym_table,
6663 Qnil))))
6665 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6666 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6667 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6668 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6669 goto done_keysym;
6672 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6673 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6674 || keysym == XK_Delete
6675 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6676 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6677 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6678 #endif
6679 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6680 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6681 #ifdef HPUX
6682 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6683 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6684 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6685 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6686 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6687 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6688 #endif
6689 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6690 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6691 #endif
6692 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6693 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6694 #endif
6695 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6696 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6697 #endif
6698 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6699 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6700 #endif
6701 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6702 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6703 #endif
6704 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6705 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6706 #endif
6707 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6708 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6709 #endif
6710 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6711 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6712 #endif
6713 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6714 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6715 #endif
6716 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6717 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6718 #endif
6719 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6720 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6721 #endif
6722 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6723 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6724 #endif
6725 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6726 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6727 #endif
6728 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6729 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6730 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6731 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6732 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6733 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6734 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6735 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6736 don't have real modifiers but
6737 should be treated similarly to
6738 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6739 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6740 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6741 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6742 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6743 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6744 #endif
6747 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6748 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6749 key. */
6750 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6751 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6752 goto done_keysym;
6755 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6756 register int i;
6757 register int c;
6758 int nchars, len;
6760 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6762 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6763 nchars++;
6764 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6767 if (nchars < nbytes)
6769 /* Decode the input data. */
6770 int require;
6771 unsigned char *p;
6773 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6774 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6775 we used just above and the locale. */
6776 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6777 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6778 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6779 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6780 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6781 gives us composition information. */
6782 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6784 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6785 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6786 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6787 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6788 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6789 nbytes = coding.produced;
6790 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6791 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6794 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6795 character events. */
6796 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6798 if (nchars == nbytes)
6799 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6800 else
6801 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6802 nbytes - i, len);
6803 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6804 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6805 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6806 inev.ie.code = c;
6807 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6810 count += nchars;
6812 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6814 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6815 break;
6818 done_keysym:
6819 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6820 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6821 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6822 client. */
6823 break;
6824 #else
6825 goto OTHER;
6826 #endif
6828 case KeyRelease:
6829 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6830 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6831 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6832 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6833 client. */
6834 break;
6835 #else
6836 goto OTHER;
6837 #endif
6839 case EnterNotify:
6840 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6841 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6843 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6845 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6846 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6848 #if 0
6849 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6851 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6852 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6853 || !(f->auto_lower)
6854 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6856 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6857 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6860 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6861 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6862 #endif
6864 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6865 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6866 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6867 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6868 #ifdef USE_GTK
6869 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6870 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6871 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6872 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6873 #endif
6874 goto OTHER;
6876 case FocusIn:
6877 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6878 goto OTHER;
6880 case LeaveNotify:
6881 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6882 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6884 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6885 if (f)
6887 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6889 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6890 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6891 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6892 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6895 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6896 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6897 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6898 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6899 if (any_help_event_p)
6900 do_help = -1;
6902 #ifdef USE_GTK
6903 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6904 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6905 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6906 #endif
6907 goto OTHER;
6909 case FocusOut:
6910 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6911 goto OTHER;
6913 case MotionNotify:
6915 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6916 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6917 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6919 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6920 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6921 f = last_mouse_frame;
6922 else
6923 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6925 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6927 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6928 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6931 if (f)
6934 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6935 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window))
6937 Lisp_Object window;
6939 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6940 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6941 0, 0, 0, 0);
6943 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6944 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6945 will be selected only when it is active. */
6946 if (WINDOWP (window)
6947 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6948 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6949 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6950 create event iff we don't leave the
6951 selected frame. */
6952 && (focus_follows_mouse
6953 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6954 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6956 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6957 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6960 last_window=window;
6962 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6963 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6965 else
6967 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6968 struct scroll_bar *bar
6969 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6970 event.xmotion.window);
6972 if (bar)
6973 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6974 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6976 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6977 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6978 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6981 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6982 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6983 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6984 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6985 do_help = 1;
6986 goto OTHER;
6989 case ConfigureNotify:
6990 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6991 #ifdef USE_GTK
6992 if (!f
6993 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6994 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6996 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6997 event.xconfigure.height);
6998 f = 0;
7000 #endif
7001 if (f)
7003 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7004 #ifndef USE_GTK
7005 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
7006 do this one, the right one will come later.
7007 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
7008 need to reset it below. */
7009 int dont_resize
7010 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
7011 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
7012 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
7013 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
7015 if (dont_resize)
7016 goto OTHER;
7018 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
7019 is called by the code that handles resizing
7020 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
7022 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
7023 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
7024 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
7025 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
7026 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
7027 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7028 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
7030 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
7031 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
7032 cancel_mouse_face (f);
7035 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
7036 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
7037 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7038 #endif
7040 #ifdef USE_GTK
7041 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
7042 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
7043 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
7044 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
7045 #endif
7047 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
7049 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
7050 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
7053 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7054 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
7055 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7056 #endif
7058 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
7060 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
7061 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
7062 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
7063 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
7066 goto OTHER;
7068 case ButtonRelease:
7069 case ButtonPress:
7071 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
7072 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
7073 int tool_bar_p = 0;
7075 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
7076 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
7077 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
7079 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
7080 && last_mouse_frame
7081 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
7082 f = last_mouse_frame;
7083 else
7084 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
7086 if (f)
7088 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
7089 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
7090 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
7092 Lisp_Object window;
7093 int x = event.xbutton.x;
7094 int y = event.xbutton.y;
7096 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
7097 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
7099 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
7101 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
7102 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
7103 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
7104 event.xbutton.state));
7108 if (!tool_bar_p)
7109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7110 if (! popup_activated ())
7111 #endif
7113 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
7115 if (event.type == ButtonPress
7116 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
7118 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7119 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
7121 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
7122 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7124 else
7125 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
7127 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
7128 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
7129 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
7131 else
7133 struct scroll_bar *bar
7134 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
7135 event.xbutton.window);
7137 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7138 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
7139 scroll bars. */
7140 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
7142 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
7143 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7145 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7146 if (bar)
7147 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
7148 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7151 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7153 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
7154 last_mouse_frame = f;
7156 if (!tool_bar_p)
7157 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7159 else
7160 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
7162 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
7163 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
7164 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
7165 if (f != 0)
7166 f->mouse_moved = 0;
7168 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7169 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
7170 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
7171 don't pass it to Xt right now.
7172 Instead, save it away
7173 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
7174 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7175 if (
7176 #ifdef USE_GTK
7177 ! popup_activated ()
7179 #endif
7180 f && event.type == ButtonPress
7181 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7182 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7183 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
7184 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7185 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
7186 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7187 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7189 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7190 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7191 #ifdef USE_GTK
7192 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7193 #endif
7195 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7197 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7198 goto OTHER;
7201 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
7202 but I am trying to be cautious. */
7203 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
7205 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
7207 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
7208 if (f->output_data.x)
7209 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7211 else
7212 goto OTHER;
7214 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
7215 else
7216 goto OTHER;
7217 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7219 break;
7221 case CirculateNotify:
7222 goto OTHER;
7224 case CirculateRequest:
7225 goto OTHER;
7227 case VisibilityNotify:
7228 goto OTHER;
7230 case MappingNotify:
7231 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7232 local cache. */
7233 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7235 case MappingModifier:
7236 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7237 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7238 case MappingKeyboard:
7239 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7241 goto OTHER;
7243 default:
7244 OTHER:
7245 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7246 BLOCK_INPUT;
7247 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7248 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7250 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7251 break;
7254 done:
7255 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7257 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7258 count++;
7261 if (do_help
7262 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7264 Lisp_Object frame;
7266 if (f)
7267 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7268 else
7269 frame = Qnil;
7271 if (do_help > 0)
7273 any_help_event_p = 1;
7274 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7275 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7277 else
7279 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7280 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7282 count++;
7285 *eventp = event;
7286 return count;
7290 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7291 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7292 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7294 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7296 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
7297 XEvent *event;
7298 Display *display;
7300 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7301 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7303 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7305 if (dpyinfo)
7306 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7308 return finish;
7312 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7313 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7314 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7316 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7317 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7318 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7319 C chars).
7321 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7323 static int
7324 XTread_socket (terminal, expected, hold_quit)
7325 struct terminal *terminal;
7326 int expected;
7327 struct input_event *hold_quit;
7329 int count = 0;
7330 XEvent event;
7331 int event_found = 0;
7332 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7334 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7336 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7337 return -1;
7340 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7341 BLOCK_INPUT;
7343 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7344 input_signal_count++;
7346 ++handling_signal;
7348 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7349 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7350 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7352 struct input_event inev;
7353 BLOCK_INPUT;
7354 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7355 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7356 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7358 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7359 count++;
7361 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7363 #endif
7365 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7366 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7368 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7369 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7372 #if 0 /* This loop is a noop now. */
7373 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7374 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7375 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7377 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7378 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7379 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7380 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7381 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7382 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7383 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7384 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7385 #endif
7387 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7388 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7389 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7390 for X connections. */
7391 #ifndef SIGIO
7392 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7393 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7395 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7396 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7397 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7398 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7400 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7401 #endif /* SIGIO */
7402 #endif
7404 #endif
7406 #ifndef USE_GTK
7407 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7409 int finish;
7411 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7413 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7414 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7415 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7416 break;
7417 #endif
7418 event_found = 1;
7420 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7421 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7423 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7424 goto out;
7427 #else /* USE_GTK */
7429 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7430 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7431 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7432 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7434 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7435 from all displays. */
7437 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7439 current_count = count;
7440 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7442 gtk_main_iteration ();
7444 count = current_count;
7445 current_count = -1;
7446 current_hold_quit = 0;
7448 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7449 break;
7451 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7453 out:;
7455 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7456 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7457 if (! event_found)
7459 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7460 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7461 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7462 x_noop_count++;
7463 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7465 x_noop_count=0;
7467 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7468 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7470 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7472 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7473 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7477 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7478 raise it now. */
7479 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7480 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7482 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7483 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7486 --handling_signal;
7487 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7489 return count;
7495 /***********************************************************************
7496 Text Cursor
7497 ***********************************************************************/
7499 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7500 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7502 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7503 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7504 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7506 static void
7507 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7508 struct window *w;
7509 struct glyph_row *row;
7510 int area;
7511 GC gc;
7513 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7514 XRectangle clip_rect;
7515 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7517 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7519 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7520 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7521 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7522 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7523 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7525 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7529 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7531 static void
7532 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7533 struct window *w;
7534 struct glyph_row *row;
7536 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7537 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7538 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7539 int x, y, wd, h;
7540 XGCValues xgcv;
7541 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7542 GC gc;
7544 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7545 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7546 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7547 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7548 return;
7550 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7551 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7552 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7554 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7555 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7556 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7557 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7558 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7559 else
7560 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7561 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7562 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7564 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7565 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7566 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7567 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7571 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7573 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7574 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7575 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7576 --gerd. */
7578 static void
7579 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7580 struct window *w;
7581 struct glyph_row *row;
7582 int width;
7583 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7585 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7586 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7588 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7589 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7590 and mini-buffer. */
7591 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7592 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7593 return;
7595 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7596 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7597 the bar might not be in the window. */
7598 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7600 struct glyph_row *row;
7601 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7602 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7604 else
7606 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7607 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7608 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7609 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7610 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7611 XGCValues xgcv;
7613 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7614 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7615 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7616 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7617 that the glyph is legible. */
7618 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7619 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7620 else
7621 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7622 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7624 if (gc)
7625 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7626 else
7628 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7629 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7632 if (width < 0)
7633 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7634 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7636 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7637 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7639 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7640 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7641 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7642 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7643 width, row->height);
7644 else
7645 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7646 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7647 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7648 row->height - width),
7649 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7650 width);
7652 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7657 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7659 static void
7660 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7661 struct frame *f;
7662 Cursor cursor;
7664 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7668 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7670 static void
7671 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7672 struct frame *f;
7673 int x, y, width, height;
7675 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7676 x, y, width, height, False);
7680 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7682 static void
7683 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7684 struct window *w;
7685 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7686 int x, y;
7687 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7688 int on_p, active_p;
7690 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7692 if (on_p)
7694 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7695 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7697 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7698 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7700 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7701 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7703 else
7704 switch (cursor_type)
7706 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7707 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7708 break;
7710 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7711 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7712 break;
7714 case BAR_CURSOR:
7715 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7716 break;
7718 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7719 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7720 break;
7722 case NO_CURSOR:
7723 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7724 break;
7726 default:
7727 abort ();
7730 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7731 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7732 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7733 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7734 #endif
7737 #ifndef XFlush
7738 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7739 #endif
7743 /* Icons. */
7745 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7748 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7749 struct frame *f;
7750 Lisp_Object file;
7752 int bitmap_id;
7754 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7755 return 1;
7757 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7758 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7759 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7760 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7762 if (STRINGP (file))
7764 #ifdef USE_GTK
7765 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7766 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7767 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7768 return 0;
7769 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7770 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7771 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7773 else
7775 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7776 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7778 int rc = -1;
7780 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7781 #ifdef USE_GTK
7782 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7783 return 0;
7784 #else
7785 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7786 if (rc != -1)
7787 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7788 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7789 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7791 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7792 if (rc == -1)
7794 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7795 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7796 if (rc == -1)
7797 return 1;
7799 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7800 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7804 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7805 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7806 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7807 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7808 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7810 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7813 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7814 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7816 return 0;
7820 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7821 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7824 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7825 struct frame *f;
7826 char *icon_name;
7828 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7829 return 1;
7832 XTextProperty text;
7833 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7834 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7835 text.format = 8;
7836 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7837 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7840 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7841 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7842 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7843 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7845 return 0;
7848 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7850 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7851 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7853 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7854 be called from a signal handler.
7857 struct x_error_message_stack {
7858 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7859 Display *dpy;
7860 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7862 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7864 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7865 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7866 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7868 static void
7869 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7870 Display *display;
7871 XErrorEvent *error;
7873 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7874 x_error_message->string,
7875 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7878 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7879 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7880 operating on.
7882 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7883 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7884 stored in *x_error_message.
7886 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7887 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7889 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7891 void x_check_errors ();
7893 void
7894 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7895 Display *dpy;
7897 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7899 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7900 XSync (dpy, False);
7902 data->dpy = dpy;
7903 data->string[0] = 0;
7904 data->prev = x_error_message;
7905 x_error_message = data;
7908 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7909 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7911 void
7912 x_uncatch_errors ()
7914 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7916 BLOCK_INPUT;
7918 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7919 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7920 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7921 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7923 tmp = x_error_message;
7924 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7925 xfree (tmp);
7926 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7929 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7930 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7931 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7933 void
7934 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7935 Display *dpy;
7936 char *format;
7938 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7939 XSync (dpy, False);
7941 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7943 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7944 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7945 x_uncatch_errors ();
7946 error (format, string);
7950 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7951 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7954 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7955 Display *dpy;
7957 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7958 XSync (dpy, False);
7960 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7963 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7965 void
7966 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7967 Display *dpy;
7969 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7972 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7973 * idea. --lorentey */
7974 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7976 void
7977 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7979 while (x_error_message)
7980 x_uncatch_errors ();
7982 #endif
7984 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7987 x_catching_errors ()
7989 return x_error_message != 0;
7992 #if 0
7993 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7994 x_trace_wire ()
7996 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7998 #endif /* ! 0 */
8001 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
8002 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
8003 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
8004 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
8005 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
8007 static SIGTYPE
8008 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
8009 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
8011 #ifdef USG
8012 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
8013 must reestablish each time */
8014 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
8015 #endif /* USG */
8019 /************************************************************************
8020 Handling X errors
8021 ************************************************************************/
8023 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
8025 static char *error_msg;
8027 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
8028 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
8029 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
8031 static void
8032 x_fatal_error_signal ()
8034 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8035 exit (70);
8038 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
8039 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
8041 static SIGTYPE
8042 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
8043 Display *dpy;
8044 char *error_message;
8046 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
8047 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8048 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
8050 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
8051 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
8052 handling_signal = 0;
8054 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
8055 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
8056 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
8057 the original message here. */
8058 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8060 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
8061 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
8063 if (dpyinfo)
8065 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
8066 frame on it. */
8067 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
8068 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
8071 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
8072 that are on the dead display. */
8073 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8075 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
8076 minibuf_frame
8077 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
8078 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8079 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
8080 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
8081 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
8082 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8085 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
8086 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
8087 for another frame that we need to delete. */
8088 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8089 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8090 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
8092 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
8093 trying to find a replacement. */
8094 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
8095 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8098 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
8099 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
8100 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
8102 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
8103 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
8104 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
8106 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
8107 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
8109 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
8110 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
8111 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
8113 if (dpyinfo)
8115 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8116 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
8117 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
8119 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
8120 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
8121 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
8122 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
8124 #endif
8126 #ifdef USE_GTK
8127 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
8128 is the last display/terminal. */
8129 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
8131 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8132 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
8133 exit (70);
8135 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
8136 #endif
8138 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
8139 dpyinfo->display = 0;
8141 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
8142 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
8143 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
8144 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
8145 abort ();
8147 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
8150 x_uncatch_errors ();
8152 if (terminal_list == 0)
8154 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8155 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
8156 exit (70);
8159 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
8160 #ifdef SIGIO
8161 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
8162 #endif
8163 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
8164 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8166 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
8167 clear_waiting_for_input ();
8168 /* FIXME: This is an asynchronous interrupt w.r.t elisp, so signalling an
8169 error might not be the best thing to do. I'd vote for creating an
8170 elisp event and stuffing it in the queue so people can bind to it via
8171 the global map. --Stef */
8172 error ("%s", error_msg);
8175 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
8176 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
8177 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
8179 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
8180 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
8182 static int
8183 x_error_handler (display, error)
8184 Display *display;
8185 XErrorEvent *error;
8187 if (x_error_message)
8188 x_error_catcher (display, error);
8189 else
8190 x_error_quitter (display, error);
8191 return 0;
8194 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
8195 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
8196 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8198 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
8200 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
8201 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
8202 #else
8203 #define NO_INLINE
8204 #endif
8206 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
8208 #ifdef noinline
8209 #undef noinline
8210 #endif
8212 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
8213 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
8215 static void NO_INLINE
8216 x_error_quitter (display, error)
8217 Display *display;
8218 XErrorEvent *error;
8220 char buf[256], buf1[356];
8222 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
8223 or colors that are not defined. */
8225 if (error->error_code == BadName)
8226 return;
8228 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
8229 original error handler. */
8231 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
8232 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
8233 buf, error->request_code);
8234 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
8238 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
8239 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
8240 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8242 static int
8243 x_io_error_quitter (display)
8244 Display *display;
8246 char buf[256];
8248 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
8249 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
8250 return 0;
8253 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8255 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
8256 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
8257 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
8258 The return value shows which font we chose. */
8260 Lisp_Object
8261 x_new_font (f, fontname)
8262 struct frame *f;
8263 register char *fontname;
8265 struct font_info *fontp
8266 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, fontname);
8268 if (!fontp)
8269 return Qnil;
8271 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font))
8272 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8273 do. */
8274 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
8276 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
8277 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
8278 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
8280 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
8281 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
8282 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
8284 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8286 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8287 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8289 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8290 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8291 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8293 else
8295 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8296 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8299 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
8300 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8302 Font fid;
8304 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
8305 if (enable_font_backend)
8306 fid = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->font->fid;
8307 else
8308 #endif
8309 fid = FRAME_FONT (f)->fid;
8310 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc, fid);
8311 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc, fid);
8312 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc, fid);
8314 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8315 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8316 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8317 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8318 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8321 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
8324 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default fontset,
8325 and return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a
8326 wildcard pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits
8327 the pattern. FONTSETNAME may be a font name for ASCII characters;
8328 in that case, we create a fontset from that font name.
8330 The return value shows which fontset we chose.
8331 If FONTSETNAME specifies the default fontset, return Qt.
8332 If an ASCII font in the specified fontset can't be loaded, return
8333 Qnil. */
8335 Lisp_Object
8336 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
8337 struct frame *f;
8338 Lisp_Object fontsetname;
8340 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (fontsetname, 0);
8341 Lisp_Object result;
8343 if (fontset > 0 && f->output_data.x->fontset == fontset)
8344 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
8345 to do. */
8346 return fontset_name (fontset);
8347 else if (fontset == 0)
8348 /* The default fontset can't be the default font. */
8349 return Qt;
8351 if (fontset > 0)
8352 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
8353 else
8354 result = x_new_font (f, SDATA (fontsetname));
8356 if (!STRINGP (result))
8357 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
8358 return Qnil;
8360 if (fontset < 0)
8361 fontset = new_fontset_from_font_name (result);
8363 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
8364 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8366 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8367 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8368 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8369 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8370 #endif
8372 return fontset_name (fontset);
8375 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
8376 Lisp_Object
8377 x_new_fontset2 (f, fontset, font_object)
8378 struct frame *f;
8379 int fontset;
8380 Lisp_Object font_object;
8382 struct font *font = XSAVE_VALUE (font_object)->pointer;
8384 if (FRAME_FONT_OBJECT (f) == font)
8385 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8386 do. */
8387 return fontset_name (fontset);
8389 BLOCK_INPUT;
8391 FRAME_FONT_OBJECT (f) = font;
8392 FRAME_FONT (f) = font->font.font;
8393 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->font.baseline_offset;
8394 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8396 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->font.average_width;
8397 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->font.space_width;
8398 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = font->font.height;
8400 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8402 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8403 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8405 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8406 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8407 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid - 1) / wid;
8409 else
8411 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8412 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8415 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
8416 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8418 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8419 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8420 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8421 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8422 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8425 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8426 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8427 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8428 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8429 #endif
8431 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8433 return fontset_name (fontset);
8435 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
8438 /***********************************************************************
8439 X Input Methods
8440 ***********************************************************************/
8442 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8444 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8446 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8447 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8448 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8450 static void
8451 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8452 XIM xim;
8453 XPointer client_data;
8454 XPointer call_data;
8456 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8457 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8459 BLOCK_INPUT;
8461 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8462 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8464 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8465 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8467 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8468 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8472 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8473 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8474 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8475 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8478 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8480 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8481 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8482 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8483 #endif
8485 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8486 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8488 static void
8489 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8490 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8491 char *resource_name;
8493 XIM xim;
8495 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8496 if (use_xim)
8498 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8499 EMACS_CLASS);
8500 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8502 if (xim)
8504 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8505 XIMCallback destroy;
8506 #endif
8508 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8509 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8511 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8512 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8513 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8514 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8515 #endif
8519 else
8520 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8521 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8525 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8527 struct xim_inst_t
8529 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8530 char *resource_name;
8533 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8534 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8535 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8536 when the callback was registered. */
8538 static void
8539 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8540 Display *display;
8541 XPointer client_data;
8542 XPointer call_data;
8544 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8545 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8547 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8548 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8549 return;
8551 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8553 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8554 as they have no XIC. */
8555 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8557 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8559 BLOCK_INPUT;
8560 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8562 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8564 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8565 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8566 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8568 create_frame_xic (f);
8569 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8570 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8571 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8573 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8574 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8579 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8583 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8586 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8587 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8588 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8589 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8591 static void
8592 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8593 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8594 char *resource_name;
8596 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8597 if (use_xim)
8599 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8600 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8601 int len;
8603 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8604 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8605 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8606 len = strlen (resource_name);
8607 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8608 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8609 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8610 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8611 xim_instantiate_callback,
8612 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8613 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8614 least, hence the configure test. */
8615 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8616 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8617 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8618 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8619 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8622 else
8623 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8624 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8628 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8630 static void
8631 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8632 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8634 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8635 if (use_xim)
8637 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8638 if (dpyinfo->display)
8639 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8640 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8641 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8642 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8643 if (dpyinfo->display)
8644 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8645 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8646 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8648 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8651 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8655 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8656 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8658 void
8659 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8660 struct frame *f;
8662 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8664 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8665 is already for the top-left corner. */
8666 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8667 return;
8669 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8670 position that fits on the screen. */
8671 if (flags & XNegative)
8672 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8673 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8676 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8678 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8679 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8680 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8682 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8683 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8684 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8685 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8686 is right, though.
8688 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8689 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8691 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8692 #endif
8694 if (flags & YNegative)
8695 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8698 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8699 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8700 so the flags should correspond. */
8701 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8704 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8705 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8706 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8707 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8708 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8710 void
8711 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8712 struct frame *f;
8713 register int xoff, yoff;
8714 int change_gravity;
8716 int modified_top, modified_left;
8718 if (change_gravity > 0)
8720 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8721 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8723 f->top_pos = yoff;
8724 f->left_pos = xoff;
8725 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8726 if (xoff < 0)
8727 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8728 if (yoff < 0)
8729 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8730 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8732 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8734 BLOCK_INPUT;
8735 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8737 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8738 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8740 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8742 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8743 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8744 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8745 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8746 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8749 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8750 modified_left, modified_top);
8752 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8753 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8754 ? 1 : 0);
8756 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8757 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8758 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8759 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8760 of the frame.
8762 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8763 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8764 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8766 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8767 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8768 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8769 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8770 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8771 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8773 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8776 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8777 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8778 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8779 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8780 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8782 static int
8783 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8784 struct frame *f;
8785 const char *atomname;
8787 Atom actual_type;
8788 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8789 int i, rc, actual_format;
8790 Atom prop_atom;
8791 Window wmcheck_window;
8792 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8793 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8794 long max_len = 65536;
8795 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8796 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8797 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8798 Atom want_atom;
8800 BLOCK_INPUT;
8802 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8804 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8805 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8806 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8807 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8808 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8810 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8812 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8813 x_uncatch_errors ();
8814 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8815 return 0;
8818 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8819 XFree (tmp_data);
8821 /* Check if window exists. */
8822 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8823 x_sync (f);
8824 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8826 x_uncatch_errors ();
8827 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8828 return 0;
8831 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8833 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8834 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8835 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8836 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8837 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8838 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8840 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8841 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8842 tmp_data = NULL;
8843 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8844 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8845 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8846 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8848 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8850 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8851 x_uncatch_errors ();
8852 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8853 return 0;
8856 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8857 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8858 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8861 rc = 0;
8862 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8864 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8865 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8867 x_uncatch_errors ();
8868 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8870 return rc;
8873 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8875 static int
8876 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8877 struct frame *f;
8879 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8881 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8882 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8883 if (!have_net_atom)
8884 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8886 if (have_net_atom)
8888 Lisp_Object frame;
8889 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8890 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8891 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8892 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8893 const char *what = NULL;
8895 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8897 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8898 hints. */
8899 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8901 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8902 what = fs;
8903 break;
8904 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8905 what = fw;
8906 break;
8907 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8908 what = fh;
8909 break;
8912 if (what != NULL && !wm_supports (f, what)) return 0;
8915 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8916 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8917 make_number (32),
8918 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8919 Fcons
8920 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8921 strlen (fs)),
8922 Qnil)));
8923 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8924 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8925 make_number (32),
8926 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8927 Fcons
8928 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8929 strlen (fh)),
8930 Qnil)));
8931 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8932 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8933 make_number (32),
8934 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8935 Fcons
8936 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8937 strlen (fw)),
8938 Qnil)));
8939 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8940 if (what != NULL)
8941 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8942 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8943 make_number (32),
8944 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8945 Fcons
8946 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8947 strlen (what)),
8948 Qnil)));
8951 return have_net_atom;
8954 static void
8955 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8956 FRAME_PTR f;
8958 if (f->async_visible)
8960 BLOCK_INPUT;
8961 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8962 x_sync (f);
8963 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8968 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8969 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8970 static void
8971 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8972 struct frame *f;
8974 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8976 int width, height, ign;
8978 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8979 return;
8981 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8983 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8985 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8986 when setting WM manager hints.
8987 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8988 x_check_expected_move. */
8989 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8991 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8992 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8993 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8995 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8996 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
9001 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
9002 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
9003 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
9004 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
9005 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
9006 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
9007 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
9009 static void
9010 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
9011 struct frame *f;
9012 int expected_left;
9013 int expected_top;
9015 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9017 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
9018 window manager window around the frame. */
9020 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9022 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
9024 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
9026 int adjusted_left;
9027 int adjusted_top;
9029 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
9030 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
9031 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
9033 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
9035 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
9036 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
9038 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9039 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
9041 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
9043 else
9044 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
9045 frame's position. */
9047 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
9051 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
9052 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
9053 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
9054 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
9055 of an exact comparison. */
9057 static void
9058 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
9059 struct frame *f;
9060 int left, top, fuzzy;
9062 int count = 0;
9064 while (count++ < 50)
9066 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9068 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
9069 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
9070 loop. */
9072 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9073 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9075 if (fuzzy)
9077 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
9078 pixels. */
9080 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
9081 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
9082 return;
9084 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
9085 return;
9088 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
9089 will then return up-to-date position info. */
9091 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
9095 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
9096 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
9097 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
9098 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9100 static void
9101 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
9102 struct frame *f;
9103 int change_gravity;
9104 int cols, rows;
9106 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
9108 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
9109 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
9110 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
9112 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
9113 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
9114 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
9116 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
9118 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
9119 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
9121 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9122 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
9124 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9125 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9126 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
9128 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9129 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9130 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9131 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9133 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9134 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9135 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9136 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9137 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9139 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9140 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
9141 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
9142 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
9143 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
9145 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9146 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9147 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9148 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9149 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9151 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9155 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9156 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
9157 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9158 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9160 void
9161 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
9162 struct frame *f;
9163 int change_gravity;
9164 int cols, rows;
9166 BLOCK_INPUT;
9168 #ifdef USE_GTK
9169 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
9170 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
9171 else
9172 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
9173 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
9175 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
9177 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
9178 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
9179 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
9180 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
9181 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
9182 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
9183 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
9184 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
9185 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
9187 else
9188 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
9190 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9192 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
9194 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9196 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9197 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
9199 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9200 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9201 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9202 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9203 cancel_mouse_face (f);
9205 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9208 /* Mouse warping. */
9210 void
9211 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
9212 struct frame *f;
9213 int x, y;
9215 int pix_x, pix_y;
9217 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
9218 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
9220 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
9221 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9223 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
9224 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9226 BLOCK_INPUT;
9228 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9229 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9233 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9235 void
9236 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
9237 struct frame *f;
9238 int pix_x, pix_y;
9240 BLOCK_INPUT;
9242 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9243 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9244 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9247 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
9249 void
9250 x_focus_on_frame (f)
9251 struct frame *f;
9253 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
9254 x_raise_frame (f);
9255 #endif
9256 #if 0
9257 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
9258 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
9259 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
9260 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9261 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9262 #endif /* ! 0 */
9265 void
9266 x_unfocus_frame (f)
9267 struct frame *f;
9269 #if 0
9270 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
9271 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
9272 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
9273 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9274 #endif /* ! 0 */
9277 /* Raise frame F. */
9279 void
9280 x_raise_frame (f)
9281 struct frame *f;
9283 BLOCK_INPUT;
9284 if (f->async_visible)
9285 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9287 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9288 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9291 /* Lower frame F. */
9293 void
9294 x_lower_frame (f)
9295 struct frame *f;
9297 if (f->async_visible)
9299 BLOCK_INPUT;
9300 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9301 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9306 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9308 void
9309 x_ewmh_activate_frame (f)
9310 FRAME_PTR f;
9312 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9313 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9315 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
9316 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
9318 Lisp_Object frame;
9319 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9320 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9321 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
9322 make_number (32),
9323 Fcons (make_number (1),
9324 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9325 Qnil)));
9329 static void
9330 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
9331 FRAME_PTR f;
9332 int raise_flag;
9334 if (raise_flag)
9335 x_raise_frame (f);
9336 else
9337 x_lower_frame (f);
9340 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9342 void
9343 xembed_set_info (f, flags)
9344 struct frame *f;
9345 enum xembed_info flags;
9347 Atom atom;
9348 unsigned long data[2];
9350 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
9352 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9353 data[1] = flags;
9355 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
9356 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9359 void
9360 xembed_send_message (f, time, message, detail, data1, data2)
9361 struct frame *f;
9362 Time time;
9363 enum xembed_message message;
9364 long detail;
9365 long data1;
9366 long data2;
9368 XEvent event;
9370 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9371 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9372 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9373 event.xclient.format = 32;
9374 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9375 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9376 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9377 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9378 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9380 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9381 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9382 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9385 /* Change of visibility. */
9387 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9388 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9389 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9390 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9391 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9392 finishes with it. */
9394 void
9395 x_make_frame_visible (f)
9396 struct frame *f;
9398 Lisp_Object type;
9399 int original_top, original_left;
9400 int retry_count = 2;
9402 retry:
9404 BLOCK_INPUT;
9406 type = x_icon_type (f);
9407 if (!NILP (type))
9408 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9410 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9412 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9413 call x_set_offset a second time
9414 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9415 before the window gets really visible. */
9416 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9417 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9418 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9419 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9421 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9423 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9424 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9425 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9426 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9427 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9428 else
9430 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9431 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9433 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9434 #ifdef USE_GTK
9435 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9436 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9437 #else
9438 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9439 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9440 else
9441 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9442 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9443 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9444 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
9445 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
9446 to come back ok without this. */
9447 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
9448 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9449 #endif
9452 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9454 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9455 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9456 so that incoming events are handled. */
9458 Lisp_Object frame;
9459 int count;
9460 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9461 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9462 will set it when they are handled. */
9463 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9465 original_left = f->left_pos;
9466 original_top = f->top_pos;
9468 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9469 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9471 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9473 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9474 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9475 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9476 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9478 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9479 because the window manager may choose the position
9480 and we don't want to override it. */
9482 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9483 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9484 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9485 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9486 && previously_visible)
9488 Drawable rootw;
9489 int x, y;
9490 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9492 BLOCK_INPUT;
9494 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9495 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9496 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9497 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9498 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9499 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9500 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9501 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9502 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9504 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9505 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9506 original_left, original_top);
9508 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9511 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9513 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9514 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9515 MapNotify at all.. */
9516 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9517 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9519 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9520 x_sync (f);
9522 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9523 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9524 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9525 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9526 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9527 probably a bug. */
9528 if (input_polling_used ())
9530 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9531 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9532 handler reset it. */
9533 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9534 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9535 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9536 poll_for_input_1 ();
9537 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9540 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9541 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9544 /* 2000-09-28: In
9546 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9547 (iconify-frame f)
9548 (raise-frame f))
9550 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9551 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9552 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9553 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9555 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9556 goto retry;
9560 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9562 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9564 void
9565 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9566 struct frame *f;
9568 Window window;
9570 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9571 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9573 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9574 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9575 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9577 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
9578 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
9579 return;
9580 #endif
9582 BLOCK_INPUT;
9584 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9585 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9586 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9587 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9588 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9589 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9591 #ifdef USE_GTK
9592 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9593 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9594 else
9595 #else
9596 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9597 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9598 else
9599 #endif
9602 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9603 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9605 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9606 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9610 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9611 just by the event that we get from the server.
9612 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9613 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9614 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9615 f->visible = 0;
9616 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9617 f->async_visible = 0;
9618 f->async_iconified = 0;
9620 x_sync (f);
9622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9625 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9627 void
9628 x_iconify_frame (f)
9629 struct frame *f;
9631 int result;
9632 Lisp_Object type;
9634 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9635 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9636 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9638 if (f->async_iconified)
9639 return;
9641 BLOCK_INPUT;
9643 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9645 type = x_icon_type (f);
9646 if (!NILP (type))
9647 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9649 #ifdef USE_GTK
9650 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9652 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9653 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9655 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9656 f->iconified = 1;
9657 f->visible = 1;
9658 f->async_iconified = 1;
9659 f->async_visible = 0;
9660 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9661 return;
9663 #endif
9665 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9667 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9669 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9670 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9671 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9672 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9673 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9674 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9675 so we have to record it here. */
9676 f->iconified = 1;
9677 f->visible = 1;
9678 f->async_iconified = 1;
9679 f->async_visible = 0;
9680 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9681 return;
9684 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9685 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9686 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9687 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9689 if (!result)
9690 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9692 f->async_iconified = 1;
9693 f->async_visible = 0;
9696 BLOCK_INPUT;
9697 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9699 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9701 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9702 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9703 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9704 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9705 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9706 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9708 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9709 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9711 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9712 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9714 XEvent message;
9716 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9717 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9718 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9719 message.xclient.format = 32;
9720 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9722 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9723 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9724 False,
9725 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9726 &message))
9728 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9729 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9733 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9734 IconicState. */
9735 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9737 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9739 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9740 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9743 f->async_iconified = 1;
9744 f->async_visible = 0;
9746 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9747 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9748 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9752 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9754 void
9755 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9756 struct frame *f;
9758 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9759 Lisp_Object bar;
9760 struct scroll_bar *b;
9762 BLOCK_INPUT;
9764 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9765 commands to the X server. */
9766 if (dpyinfo->display)
9768 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
9769 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9770 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9771 face. */
9772 if (enable_font_backend
9773 && FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9774 free_frame_faces (f);
9775 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
9777 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9778 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9780 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9781 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9782 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9783 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9784 toolkit scroll bars. */
9785 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9787 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9788 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9790 #endif
9792 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9793 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9794 free_frame_xic (f);
9795 #endif
9797 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9798 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9800 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9801 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9803 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9804 we are using a toolkit. */
9805 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9806 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9808 free_frame_menubar (f);
9809 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9811 #ifdef USE_GTK
9812 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9813 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9814 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9816 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9817 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9818 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9820 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9822 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9823 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9824 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9826 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9827 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9828 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9829 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9830 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9831 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9833 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9834 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9835 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9836 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9837 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9838 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9839 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9840 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9841 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9842 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9843 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9844 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9845 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9846 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9847 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9849 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9850 free_frame_faces (f);
9852 x_free_gcs (f);
9853 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9856 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9857 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9859 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9860 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9862 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9863 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9864 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9865 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9866 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9867 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9869 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9871 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9872 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9873 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9874 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9875 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9876 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9877 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9880 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9884 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9886 void
9887 x_destroy_window (f)
9888 struct frame *f;
9890 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9892 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9893 commands to the X server. */
9894 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9895 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9897 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9901 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9903 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9904 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9905 that the window now has.
9906 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9907 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9908 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9910 #ifndef USE_GTK
9911 void
9912 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9913 struct frame *f;
9914 long flags;
9915 int user_position;
9917 XSizeHints size_hints;
9919 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9920 Arg al[2];
9921 int ac = 0;
9922 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9923 #endif
9925 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9927 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9928 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9930 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9931 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9933 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9934 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9935 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9936 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9937 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9938 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9939 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9940 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9941 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9942 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9944 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9945 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9946 size_hints.max_width
9947 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9948 size_hints.max_height
9949 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9951 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9953 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9954 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9955 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9957 int base_width, base_height;
9958 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9960 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9961 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9963 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9965 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9966 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9967 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9968 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9969 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9971 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9972 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9973 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9975 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9976 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9977 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9978 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9979 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9982 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9983 if (flags)
9985 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9986 goto no_read;
9988 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9991 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9992 long supplied_return;
9993 int value;
9995 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9996 &supplied_return);
9998 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9999 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
10000 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
10001 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
10002 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
10003 #endif
10005 if (flags)
10006 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10007 else
10009 if (value == 0)
10010 hints.flags = 0;
10011 if (hints.flags & PSize)
10012 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
10013 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
10014 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
10015 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
10016 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10017 if (hints.flags & USSize)
10018 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
10022 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10023 no_read:
10024 #endif
10026 #ifdef PWinGravity
10027 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
10028 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
10030 if (user_position)
10032 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
10033 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10035 #endif /* PWinGravity */
10037 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
10039 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10041 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10043 void
10044 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
10045 struct frame *f;
10046 int state;
10048 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10049 Arg al[1];
10051 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
10052 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10053 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10054 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10056 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
10057 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
10059 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10060 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10063 void
10064 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
10065 struct frame *f;
10066 int pixmap_id;
10068 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
10070 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10071 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10072 #endif
10074 if (pixmap_id > 0)
10076 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
10077 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
10078 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
10079 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
10081 else
10083 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
10084 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
10085 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
10086 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
10087 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
10088 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
10089 best to explicitly give up. */
10090 #if 0
10091 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
10092 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
10093 #else
10094 return;
10095 #endif
10099 #ifdef USE_GTK
10101 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
10102 return;
10105 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10108 Arg al[1];
10109 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
10110 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10111 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
10112 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10115 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10117 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
10118 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10120 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10123 void
10124 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
10125 struct frame *f;
10126 int icon_x, icon_y;
10128 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10130 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
10131 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
10132 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
10134 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10138 /***********************************************************************
10139 Fonts
10140 ***********************************************************************/
10142 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
10144 struct font_info *
10145 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
10146 FRAME_PTR f;
10147 int font_idx;
10149 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
10153 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
10155 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
10156 to be listed.
10158 SIZE < 0 means include auto scaled fonts.
10160 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
10161 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
10162 on how many fonts to match. */
10164 Lisp_Object
10165 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
10166 struct frame *f;
10167 Lisp_Object pattern;
10168 int size;
10169 int maxnames;
10171 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
10172 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
10173 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
10174 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
10175 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10176 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
10177 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
10179 if (size < 0)
10181 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
10182 size = 0;
10185 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
10186 if (NILP (patterns))
10187 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
10189 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
10190 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
10191 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
10193 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
10195 int num_fonts;
10196 char **names = NULL;
10198 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
10199 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
10200 The cache is an alist of the form:
10201 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
10202 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
10203 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
10204 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
10205 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
10206 if (!NILP (list))
10208 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
10209 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
10210 goto label_cached;
10213 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
10215 BLOCK_INPUT;
10216 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10218 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
10220 XFontStruct *font;
10221 unsigned long value;
10223 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
10224 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10226 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10227 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10228 font = NULL;
10229 x_clear_errors (dpy);
10232 if (font
10233 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10235 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
10236 int len = strlen (name);
10237 char *tmp;
10239 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
10240 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
10241 string. We must avoid such a name. */
10242 if (len == 0)
10243 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
10244 else
10246 num_fonts = 1;
10247 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
10248 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
10249 simple var. */
10250 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
10251 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
10252 XFree (name);
10255 else
10256 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
10258 if (font)
10259 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
10262 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
10264 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
10265 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
10266 if (maxnames < 0)
10268 int limit;
10270 for (limit = 500;;)
10272 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
10273 if (num_fonts == limit)
10275 BLOCK_INPUT;
10276 XFreeFontNames (names);
10277 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10278 limit *= 2;
10280 else
10281 break;
10284 else
10285 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
10286 &num_fonts);
10288 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10290 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10291 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10292 names = NULL;
10293 x_clear_errors (dpy);
10297 x_uncatch_errors ();
10298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10300 if (names)
10302 int i;
10304 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
10305 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
10306 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
10308 int width = 0;
10309 char *p = names[i];
10310 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
10312 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
10313 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
10314 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
10315 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
10316 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
10317 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
10318 while (*p)
10319 if (*p++ == '-')
10321 dashes++;
10322 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
10323 width = atoi (p);
10324 else if (dashes == 9)
10325 resx = atoi (p);
10326 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
10327 average_width = atoi (p);
10330 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
10331 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
10333 tem = build_string (names[i]);
10334 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
10336 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
10337 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
10338 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
10339 >= 0))
10340 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
10341 width of this font. */
10342 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
10343 else
10344 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
10345 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
10350 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
10352 BLOCK_INPUT;
10353 XFreeFontNames (names);
10354 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10358 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
10359 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10360 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10362 label_cached:
10363 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
10365 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
10366 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
10367 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10369 int found_size;
10371 tem = XCAR (list);
10373 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
10374 continue;
10375 if (!size)
10377 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
10378 continue;
10381 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
10383 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
10384 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
10385 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
10387 BLOCK_INPUT;
10388 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10389 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
10390 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
10391 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10393 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10394 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10395 thisinfo = NULL;
10396 x_clear_errors (dpy);
10398 x_uncatch_errors ();
10399 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10401 if (thisinfo)
10403 XSETCDR (tem,
10404 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
10405 ? make_number (0)
10406 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
10407 BLOCK_INPUT;
10408 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
10409 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10411 else
10412 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
10413 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
10414 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
10415 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
10418 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
10419 if (found_size == size)
10420 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
10421 else if (found_size > 0)
10423 if (NILP (second_best))
10424 second_best = tem;
10425 else if (found_size < size)
10427 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
10428 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
10429 second_best = tem;
10431 else
10433 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
10434 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
10435 second_best = tem;
10439 if (!NILP (newlist))
10440 break;
10441 else if (!NILP (second_best))
10443 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
10444 break;
10448 return newlist;
10452 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
10454 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10455 font table. */
10457 static void
10458 x_check_font (f, font)
10459 struct frame *f;
10460 XFontStruct *font;
10462 int i;
10463 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10465 xassert (font != NULL);
10467 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
10468 if (enable_font_backend)
10469 /* Fixme: Perhaps we should check all cached fonts. */
10470 return;
10471 #endif
10472 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10473 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10474 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
10475 break;
10477 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
10480 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
10482 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
10483 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
10484 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
10485 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
10486 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10488 static INLINE void
10489 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
10490 XFontStruct *font;
10491 int *w, *h;
10493 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10494 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
10496 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10497 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10498 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10499 if (*w <= 0)
10500 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
10504 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10505 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10506 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10507 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10508 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10510 static int
10511 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
10512 struct frame *f;
10514 int i;
10515 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10516 XFontStruct *font;
10517 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
10518 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
10520 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
10521 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
10523 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10524 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10526 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10527 int w, h;
10529 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
10530 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
10531 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
10533 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
10534 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
10537 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
10538 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
10540 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
10541 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
10542 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
10546 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10547 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10548 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10549 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10551 struct font_info *
10552 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
10553 struct frame *f;
10554 register char *fontname;
10555 int size;
10557 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10558 Lisp_Object font_names;
10560 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10561 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10562 we already have by comparing names. */
10563 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
10565 if (!NILP (font_names))
10567 Lisp_Object tail;
10568 int i;
10570 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10571 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10572 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10573 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
10574 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
10575 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
10576 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
10577 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10580 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10582 char *full_name;
10583 XFontStruct *font;
10584 struct font_info *fontp;
10585 unsigned long value;
10586 int i;
10588 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10589 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10590 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10591 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10592 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10593 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
10594 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
10596 BLOCK_INPUT;
10597 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10598 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10599 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10601 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10602 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10603 font = NULL;
10604 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10606 x_uncatch_errors ();
10607 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10608 if (!font)
10609 return NULL;
10611 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10612 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10613 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10614 break;
10616 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10617 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10618 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10620 int sz;
10621 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10622 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10623 dpyinfo->font_table
10624 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10627 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10628 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10629 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10631 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10632 BLOCK_INPUT;
10633 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
10634 fontp->font = font;
10635 fontp->font_idx = i;
10636 fontp->charset = -1; /* fs_load_font sets it. */
10637 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10638 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
10640 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
10642 /* Fixed width font. */
10643 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
10645 else
10647 XChar2b char2b;
10648 XCharStruct *pcm;
10650 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
10651 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
10652 if (pcm)
10653 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
10654 else
10655 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10657 fontp->average_width
10658 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
10659 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
10660 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
10661 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
10662 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
10664 if (pcm)
10666 int width = pcm->width;
10667 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
10668 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
10669 width += pcm->width;
10670 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
10672 else
10673 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10677 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10678 full_name = 0;
10679 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10681 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
10682 char *p = name;
10683 int dashes = 0;
10685 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10686 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10687 so don't use it.
10688 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10689 stored in them. */
10690 while (*p)
10692 if (*p == '-')
10693 dashes++;
10694 p++;
10697 if (dashes >= 13)
10699 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
10700 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
10703 XFree (name);
10706 if (full_name != 0)
10707 fontp->full_name = full_name;
10708 else
10709 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10711 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10712 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10714 if (NILP (font_names))
10716 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10717 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10718 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10719 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
10720 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
10721 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
10722 Qnil);
10724 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10725 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10726 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10727 make_number (fontp->size)),
10728 Qnil)),
10729 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10730 if (full_name)
10732 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
10733 Qnil);
10734 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10735 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10736 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10737 make_number (fontp->size)),
10738 Qnil)),
10739 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10743 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10744 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10745 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10746 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10747 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10748 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding_type
10749 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10750 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10751 fontp->encoding_type
10752 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10753 /* 1-byte font */
10754 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10755 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10756 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10757 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10758 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10759 /* 2-byte font */
10760 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10761 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10762 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10763 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10764 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10765 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10766 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10767 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10768 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10769 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10770 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10771 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10772 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10774 fontp->baseline_offset
10775 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10776 ? (long) value : 0);
10777 fontp->relative_compose
10778 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10779 ? (long) value : 0);
10780 fontp->default_ascent
10781 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10782 ? (long) value : 0);
10784 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10785 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10786 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10787 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10788 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10789 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10791 return fontp;
10796 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10797 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10799 struct font_info *
10800 x_query_font (f, fontname)
10801 struct frame *f;
10802 register char *fontname;
10804 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10805 int i;
10807 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10808 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10809 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10810 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10811 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10812 return NULL;
10816 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10817 `encoder' of the structure. */
10819 void
10820 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10821 struct font_info *fontp;
10823 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10825 elt = Qnil;
10826 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10828 elt = XCAR (list);
10829 if (CONSP (elt)
10830 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10831 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10832 >= 0)
10833 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10834 >= 0)))
10835 break;
10838 if (! NILP (list))
10840 struct ccl_program *ccl
10841 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10843 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10844 xfree (ccl);
10845 else
10846 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10851 /* Return a char-table whose elements are t if the font FONT_INFO
10852 contains a glyph for the corresponding character, and nil if
10853 not. */
10855 Lisp_Object
10856 x_get_font_repertory (f, font_info)
10857 FRAME_PTR f;
10858 struct font_info *font_info;
10860 XFontStruct *font = (XFontStruct *) font_info->font;
10861 Lisp_Object table;
10862 int min_byte1, max_byte1, min_byte2, max_byte2;
10863 int c;
10864 struct charset *charset = CHARSET_FROM_ID (font_info->charset);
10865 int offset = CHARSET_OFFSET (charset);
10867 table = Fmake_char_table (Qnil, Qnil);
10869 min_byte1 = font->min_byte1;
10870 max_byte1 = font->max_byte1;
10871 min_byte2 = font->min_char_or_byte2;
10872 max_byte2 = font->max_char_or_byte2;
10873 if (min_byte1 == 0 && max_byte1 == 0)
10875 if (! font->per_char || font->all_chars_exist == True)
10877 if (offset >= 0)
10878 char_table_set_range (table, offset + min_byte2,
10879 offset + max_byte2, Qt);
10880 else
10881 for (; min_byte2 <= max_byte2; min_byte2++)
10883 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, min_byte2);
10884 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10887 else
10889 XCharStruct *pcm = font->per_char;
10890 int from = -1;
10891 int i;
10893 for (i = min_byte2; i <= max_byte2; i++, pcm++)
10895 if (pcm->width == 0 && pcm->rbearing == pcm->lbearing)
10897 if (from >= 0)
10899 if (offset >= 0)
10900 char_table_set_range (table, offset + from,
10901 offset + i - 1, Qt);
10902 else
10903 for (; from < i; from++)
10905 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, from);
10906 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10908 from = -1;
10911 else if (from < 0)
10912 from = i;
10914 if (from >= 0)
10916 if (offset >= 0)
10917 char_table_set_range (table, offset + from, offset + i - 1,
10918 Qt);
10919 else
10920 for (; from < i; from++)
10922 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, from);
10923 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10928 else
10930 if (! font->per_char || font->all_chars_exist == True)
10932 int i, j;
10934 if (offset >= 0)
10935 for (i = min_byte1; i <= max_byte1; i++)
10936 char_table_set_range
10937 (table, offset + ((i << 8) | min_byte2),
10938 offset + ((i << 8) | max_byte2), Qt);
10939 else
10940 for (i = min_byte1; i <= max_byte1; i++)
10941 for (j = min_byte2; j <= max_byte2; j++)
10943 unsigned code = (i << 8) | j;
10944 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, code);
10945 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10948 else
10950 XCharStruct *pcm = font->per_char;
10951 int i;
10953 for (i = min_byte1; i <= max_byte1; i++)
10955 int from = -1;
10956 int j;
10958 for (j = min_byte2; j <= max_byte2; j++, pcm++)
10960 if (pcm->width == 0 && pcm->rbearing == pcm->lbearing)
10962 if (from >= 0)
10964 if (offset >= 0)
10965 char_table_set_range
10966 (table, offset + ((i << 8) | from),
10967 offset + ((i << 8) | (j - 1)), Qt);
10968 else
10970 for (; from < j; from++)
10972 unsigned code = (i << 8) | from;
10973 c = ENCODE_CHAR (charset, code);
10974 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
10977 from = -1;
10980 else if (from < 0)
10981 from = j;
10983 if (from >= 0)
10985 if (offset >= 0)
10986 char_table_set_range
10987 (table, offset + ((i << 8) | from),
10988 offset + ((i << 8) | (j - 1)), Qt);
10989 else
10991 for (; from < j; from++)
10993 unsigned code = (i << 8) | from;
10994 c = DECODE_CHAR (charset, code);
10995 CHAR_TABLE_SET (table, c, Qt);
11003 return table;
11006 /***********************************************************************
11007 Initialization
11008 ***********************************************************************/
11010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11011 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
11012 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11013 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
11015 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
11016 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11017 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11019 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11020 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11021 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11022 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11023 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11024 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11025 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
11028 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
11030 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
11032 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11034 static int x_initialized;
11036 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11037 static int x_session_initialized;
11038 #endif
11040 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11041 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
11042 the screen number from the server number. */
11043 static int
11044 same_x_server (name1, name2)
11045 const char *name1, *name2;
11047 int seen_colon = 0;
11048 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
11049 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
11050 int length_until_period = 0;
11052 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
11053 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
11054 length_until_period++;
11056 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
11057 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
11058 name1 += 4;
11059 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
11060 name2 += 4;
11061 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
11062 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
11063 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
11064 name1 += system_name_length;
11065 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
11066 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
11067 name2 += system_name_length;
11068 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
11069 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
11070 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
11071 name1 += length_until_period;
11072 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
11073 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
11074 name2 += length_until_period;
11076 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
11078 if (*name1 == ':')
11079 seen_colon++;
11080 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
11081 return 1;
11083 return (seen_colon
11084 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
11085 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
11087 #endif
11089 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
11090 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
11091 to 5. */
11092 static void
11093 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
11094 unsigned long mask;
11095 int *bits;
11096 int *offset;
11098 int nr = 0;
11099 int off = 0;
11101 while (!(mask & 1))
11103 off++;
11104 mask >>= 1;
11107 while (mask & 1)
11109 nr++;
11110 mask >>= 1;
11113 *offset = off;
11114 *bits = nr;
11117 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
11118 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
11121 x_display_ok (display)
11122 const char *display;
11124 int dpy_ok = 1;
11125 Display *dpy;
11127 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
11128 if (dpy)
11129 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
11130 else
11131 dpy_ok = 0;
11132 return dpy_ok;
11135 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
11136 the structure that describes the open display.
11137 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
11139 struct x_display_info *
11140 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
11141 Lisp_Object display_name;
11142 char *xrm_option;
11143 char *resource_name;
11145 int connection;
11146 Display *dpy;
11147 struct terminal *terminal;
11148 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11149 XrmDatabase xrdb;
11151 BLOCK_INPUT;
11153 if (!x_initialized)
11155 x_initialize ();
11156 ++x_initialized;
11159 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
11160 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
11162 #ifdef USE_GTK
11164 #define NUM_ARGV 10
11165 int argc;
11166 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
11167 char **argv2 = argv;
11168 GdkAtom atom;
11170 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
11171 if (!EQ (Vinitial_window_system, intern ("x")))
11172 error ("Sorry, you cannot connect to X servers with the GTK toolkit");
11173 #endif
11175 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
11177 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
11178 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
11179 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
11180 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
11181 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
11182 #endif
11183 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
11185 else
11187 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
11188 argv[argc] = 0;
11190 argc = 0;
11191 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
11193 if (! NILP (display_name))
11195 argv[argc++] = "--display";
11196 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
11199 argv[argc++] = "--name";
11200 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
11202 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
11204 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
11206 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
11207 fixup_locale ();
11208 xg_initialize ();
11210 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
11212 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
11213 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
11215 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
11217 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
11218 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
11220 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
11221 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
11223 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
11224 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
11227 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11228 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11231 #else /* not USE_GTK */
11232 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11233 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
11234 errors with X11R5:
11235 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
11236 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
11237 So let's not use it until R6. */
11238 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
11239 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
11240 #endif
11243 int argc = 0;
11244 char *argv[3];
11246 argv[0] = "";
11247 argc = 1;
11248 if (xrm_option)
11250 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
11251 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
11253 turn_on_atimers (0);
11254 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
11255 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
11256 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
11257 &argc, argv);
11258 turn_on_atimers (1);
11260 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
11261 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
11262 fixup_locale ();
11263 #endif
11266 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11267 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
11268 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
11269 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11270 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
11272 /* Detect failure. */
11273 if (dpy == 0)
11275 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11276 return 0;
11279 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
11281 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
11282 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
11284 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
11286 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11288 struct x_display_info *share;
11289 Lisp_Object tail;
11291 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
11292 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
11293 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
11294 SDATA (display_name)))
11295 break;
11296 if (share)
11297 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
11298 else
11300 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
11301 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
11302 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = intern ("x");
11303 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
11305 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
11306 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11307 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
11308 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
11309 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
11310 BLOCK_INPUT;
11313 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
11314 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
11315 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
11316 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
11317 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
11318 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
11319 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
11321 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
11323 #endif
11325 /* Put this display on the chain. */
11326 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
11327 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
11329 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
11330 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
11331 x_display_name_list);
11332 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
11334 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
11336 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
11337 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
11338 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
11339 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
11341 #if 0
11342 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
11343 #endif /* ! 0 */
11345 dpyinfo->x_id_name
11346 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
11347 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
11348 + 2);
11349 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
11350 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
11352 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
11353 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
11355 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
11356 #ifdef USE_GTK
11357 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
11358 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
11359 #endif /* USE_GTK */
11361 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
11362 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
11364 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
11365 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
11366 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11367 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
11368 #else
11369 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
11370 #endif
11371 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
11372 all versions. */
11373 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
11375 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
11376 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
11377 select_visual (dpyinfo);
11378 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11379 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11380 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11381 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11382 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
11383 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
11384 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
11385 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
11386 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
11387 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
11388 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
11389 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11390 dpyinfo->font = XLoadQueryFont (dpyinfo->display, "fixed");
11391 if (! dpyinfo->font)
11392 dpyinfo->font = XLoadQueryFont (dpyinfo->display, "*");
11393 if (! dpyinfo->font)
11394 abort ();
11395 #endif /* USE_FONT_BACKEND */
11396 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
11397 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
11398 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
11399 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
11400 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
11401 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
11402 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
11403 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
11404 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11405 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
11406 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
11407 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
11408 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
11409 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
11410 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
11411 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
11412 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
11413 dpyinfo->terminal->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
11414 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
11416 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
11417 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
11418 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
11420 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
11422 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
11423 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
11424 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
11425 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
11426 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
11427 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
11430 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
11431 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
11433 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
11435 Lisp_Object value;
11436 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
11437 build_string ("privateColormap"),
11438 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
11439 Qnil, Qnil);
11440 if (STRINGP (value)
11441 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
11442 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
11443 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
11446 else
11447 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11448 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
11451 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11452 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11453 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11454 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11455 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11456 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11457 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11458 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11459 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11462 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
11463 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
11464 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
11465 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
11466 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
11467 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
11468 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
11469 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
11470 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
11471 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
11472 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
11473 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
11474 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
11475 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
11476 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
11477 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
11478 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
11479 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
11480 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
11481 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
11482 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
11483 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
11484 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
11485 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
11486 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
11487 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
11488 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
11489 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
11490 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
11491 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
11492 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
11493 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
11494 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
11495 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
11496 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
11497 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
11498 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
11499 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
11500 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
11501 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
11502 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
11503 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
11504 /* For properties of font. */
11505 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
11506 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
11507 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
11508 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
11509 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
11510 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
11511 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
11512 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
11513 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
11514 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
11516 /* Ghostscript support. */
11517 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
11518 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
11520 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
11521 False);
11523 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
11524 False);
11526 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
11528 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
11529 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
11530 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
11531 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
11533 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
11534 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
11535 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
11537 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
11538 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
11541 char null_bits[1];
11543 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
11545 dpyinfo->null_pixel
11546 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11547 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
11552 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
11553 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
11554 dpyinfo->gray
11555 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11556 gray_bitmap_bits,
11557 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
11558 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
11561 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11562 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
11563 #endif
11565 #ifdef subprocesses
11566 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
11567 if (connection != 0)
11568 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
11569 #endif
11571 #ifdef F_SETOWN
11572 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
11573 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
11575 #ifdef SIGIO
11576 if (interrupt_input)
11577 init_sigio (connection);
11578 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
11580 #ifdef USE_LUCID
11582 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
11583 XrmValue d, fr, to;
11584 Font font;
11586 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
11587 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
11588 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
11589 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
11590 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
11591 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
11592 x_catch_errors (dpy);
11593 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
11594 abort ();
11595 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
11596 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11597 x_uncatch_errors ();
11599 #endif
11601 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11602 for debugging X code. */
11604 Lisp_Object value;
11605 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
11606 build_string ("synchronous"),
11607 build_string ("Synchronous"),
11608 Qnil, Qnil);
11609 if (STRINGP (value)
11610 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
11611 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
11612 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
11616 Lisp_Object value;
11617 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
11618 build_string ("useXIM"),
11619 build_string ("UseXIM"),
11620 Qnil, Qnil);
11621 #ifdef USE_XIM
11622 if (STRINGP (value)
11623 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
11624 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
11625 use_xim = 0;
11626 #else
11627 if (STRINGP (value)
11628 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
11629 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
11630 use_xim = 1;
11631 #endif
11634 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11635 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11636 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11637 tty. */
11638 if (terminal->id == 1)
11639 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
11640 #endif
11642 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11644 return dpyinfo;
11647 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11648 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11650 void
11651 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
11652 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11654 int i;
11655 struct terminal *t;
11657 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11658 X display. */
11659 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
11660 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
11662 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11663 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11664 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11665 x_session_close();
11666 #endif
11667 delete_terminal (t);
11668 break;
11671 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
11673 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
11674 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
11675 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
11676 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11677 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
11678 else
11680 Lisp_Object tail;
11682 tail = x_display_name_list;
11683 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
11685 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11687 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
11688 break;
11690 tail = XCDR (tail);
11694 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11695 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11697 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11698 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11699 else
11701 struct x_display_info *tail;
11703 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11704 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11705 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11708 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
11709 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
11710 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11711 #endif
11712 #endif
11713 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11714 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11715 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11716 #endif
11718 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11719 if (! enable_font_backend)
11721 #endif
11722 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
11723 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11724 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11726 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
11727 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
11728 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
11731 if (dpyinfo->font_table)
11733 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
11734 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
11735 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
11737 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11739 #endif
11741 if (dpyinfo->x_id_name)
11742 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
11744 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11745 xfree (dpyinfo);
11748 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11750 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11751 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11752 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11753 that slows us down. */
11755 static void
11756 x_process_timeouts (timer)
11757 struct atimer *timer;
11759 BLOCK_INPUT;
11760 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
11761 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11763 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11764 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11765 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11766 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11768 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11771 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11772 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11773 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11774 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11775 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11776 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11777 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11779 void
11780 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
11782 BLOCK_INPUT;
11783 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11785 EMACS_TIME interval;
11787 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
11788 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11789 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
11791 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11794 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11797 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11799 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
11801 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11803 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11804 x_produce_glyphs,
11805 x_write_glyphs,
11806 x_insert_glyphs,
11807 x_clear_end_of_line,
11808 x_scroll_run,
11809 x_after_update_window_line,
11810 x_update_window_begin,
11811 x_update_window_end,
11812 x_cursor_to,
11813 x_flush,
11814 #ifdef XFlush
11815 x_flush,
11816 #else
11817 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11818 #endif
11819 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11820 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11821 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11822 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11823 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11824 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11825 x_per_char_metric,
11826 x_encode_char,
11827 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11828 x_draw_glyph_string,
11829 x_define_frame_cursor,
11830 x_clear_frame_area,
11831 x_draw_window_cursor,
11832 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11833 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11837 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11838 void
11839 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
11841 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
11842 int i;
11844 /* Protect against recursive calls. Fdelete_frame in
11845 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11846 if (!terminal->name)
11847 return;
11849 BLOCK_INPUT;
11850 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
11851 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
11852 if (dpyinfo->display)
11854 #ifdef USE_FONT_BACKEND
11855 if (enable_font_backend)
11856 XFreeFont (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->font);
11857 else
11858 #endif
11859 /* Free the fonts in the font table. */
11860 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11861 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11863 XFreeFont (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->font_table[i].font);
11866 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
11867 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
11869 #ifdef USE_GTK
11870 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
11871 #else
11872 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11873 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11874 #else
11875 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11876 #endif
11877 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11880 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
11881 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11884 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11885 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11887 static struct terminal *
11888 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11890 struct terminal *terminal;
11892 terminal = create_terminal ();
11894 terminal->type = output_x_window;
11895 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
11896 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
11898 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11900 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11901 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11902 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11903 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11904 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
11905 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
11906 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11907 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11908 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
11909 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11910 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11911 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11912 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11913 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11914 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11915 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11916 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11917 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11918 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11920 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
11921 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
11923 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
11924 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
11925 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
11926 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
11927 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
11928 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
11929 off the bottom. */
11931 return terminal;
11934 void
11935 x_initialize ()
11937 baud_rate = 19200;
11939 x_noop_count = 0;
11940 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11941 any_help_event_p = 0;
11942 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11943 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11944 x_session_initialized = 0;
11945 #endif
11947 #ifdef USE_GTK
11948 current_count = -1;
11949 #endif
11951 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11952 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
11954 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11955 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11957 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11959 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11960 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11961 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11962 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11963 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11964 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11965 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11967 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11968 #endif
11970 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11971 #ifndef USE_GTK
11972 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11973 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11974 #endif
11975 #endif
11977 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11978 original error handler. */
11979 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11980 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11982 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11983 #if 0 /* Don't. We may want to open tty frames later. */
11984 #ifdef SIGWINCH
11985 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
11986 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11987 #endif
11989 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
11993 void
11994 syms_of_xterm ()
11996 x_error_message = NULL;
11998 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
11999 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
12001 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
12002 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
12004 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
12005 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
12007 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
12008 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
12010 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
12011 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
12013 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
12014 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
12015 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
12016 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
12017 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
12018 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
12019 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
12021 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
12022 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
12023 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
12024 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
12025 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
12026 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
12027 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
12029 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
12030 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
12031 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
12032 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
12033 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
12034 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
12035 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
12036 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
12037 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
12039 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
12040 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
12041 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
12042 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
12043 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
12044 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
12045 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
12046 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
12047 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
12048 #elif USE_GTK
12049 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
12050 #else
12051 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
12052 #endif
12053 #else
12054 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
12055 #endif
12057 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
12058 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
12060 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
12061 Qalt = intern ("alt");
12062 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
12063 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
12064 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
12065 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
12066 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
12067 Qsuper = intern ("super");
12068 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
12070 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
12071 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
12072 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12073 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
12074 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
12075 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
12077 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
12078 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
12079 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12080 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
12081 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
12082 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
12084 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
12085 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
12086 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12087 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
12088 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
12089 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
12091 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
12092 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
12093 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12094 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
12095 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
12096 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
12098 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
12099 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
12100 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
12101 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
12102 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
12103 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
12106 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
12108 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
12109 (do not change this comment) */